Nitpick: ly:spanner-bound grob name slur -> spanner.
[lilypond.git] / tex / texinfo.tex
blobc7c92b8de7940f0cafbf0b77ec7da57b370e5016
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
6 \def\texinfoversion{2008-12-16.21}
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
15 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
25 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
26 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
27 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
29 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
30 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
31 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
32 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
33 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
34 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
35 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
37 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
38 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
39 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
41 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
42 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
43 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
44 % tex foo.texi
45 % texindex foo.??
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % tex foo.texi
48 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
49 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
50 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
51 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
53 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
54 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
55 % full Texinfo distribution.
57 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
60 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
62 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
63 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
64 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
65 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
66 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
69 \chardef\other=12
71 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
72 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
73 \let\+ = \relax
75 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
76 \let\ptexb=\b
77 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
78 \let\ptexc=\c
79 \let\ptexcomma=\,
80 \let\ptexdot=\.
81 \let\ptexdots=\dots
82 \let\ptexend=\end
83 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
84 \let\ptexexclam=\!
85 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
86 \let\ptexgtr=>
87 \let\ptexhat=^
88 \let\ptexi=\i
89 \let\ptexindent=\indent
90 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
91 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
92 \let\ptexless=<
93 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
94 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
95 \let\ptexplus=+
96 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
97 \let\ptexslash=\/
98 \let\ptexstar=\*
99 \let\ptext=\t
100 \let\ptextop=\top
101 {\catcode`\'=\active
102 \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% Math-mode def from plain.tex.
104 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
105 % starts a new line in the output.
106 \newlinechar = `^^J
108 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
109 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
111 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
112 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
113 \else
114 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
117 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
118 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
119 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
120 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
155 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
157 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
158 \chardef\spacecat = 10
159 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
161 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
162 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
163 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
164 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
165 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
166 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
167 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
168 \chardef\questChar = `\?
169 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
170 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
171 \chardef\underChar = `\_
173 % Ignore a token.
175 \def\gobble#1{}
177 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
178 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
180 % Hyphenation fixes.
181 \hyphenation{
182 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
183 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
184 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
185 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
186 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
187 spell-ing spell-ings
188 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
189 wide-spread wrap-around
192 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
193 \newdimen\bindingoffset
194 \newdimen\normaloffset
195 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
197 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
198 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
199 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
201 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
203 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
204 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
205 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
206 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
207 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
209 \def\|{%
210 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
211 \leavevmode
213 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
214 \vadjust{%
215 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
216 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
217 \vskip-\baselineskip
219 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
220 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
221 \llap{%
223 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
224 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
226 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
227 \hskip 12pt
232 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
233 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
234 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
235 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
236 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
238 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
239 \def\loggingall{%
240 \tracingstats2
241 \tracingpages1
242 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
243 \tracingparagraphs1
244 \tracingoutput1
245 \tracingmacros2
246 \tracingrestores1
247 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
248 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
249 \tracingscantokens1
250 \tracingifs1
251 \tracinggroups1
252 \tracingnesting2
253 \tracingassigns1
255 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
256 \errorcontextlines16
259 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
260 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
262 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
263 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
264 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
265 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
266 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
267 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
269 % For @cropmarks command.
270 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
272 \newif\ifcropmarks
273 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
275 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
276 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
278 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
279 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
280 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
281 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
283 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
284 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
285 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
287 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
288 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
290 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
291 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
292 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
293 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
294 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
295 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
296 \def\domark{%
297 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
298 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
299 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
300 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
301 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
302 \mark{%
303 \the\toks0 \the\toks2
304 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6
305 \noexpand\else \the\toks8
308 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
309 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
310 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
311 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
312 % first @chapter.
313 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
314 \ifcase0\topmark\fi
315 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
317 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
318 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
320 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
321 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
322 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
323 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
324 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
325 \def\lastcolordefs{}
327 % Main output routine.
328 \chardef\PAGE = 255
329 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
331 \newbox\headlinebox
332 \newbox\footlinebox
334 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
335 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
336 \def\onepageout#1{%
337 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
339 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
340 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
342 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
343 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
344 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
345 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
346 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
347 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
350 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
351 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
352 % before the \shipout runs.
354 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
355 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
356 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
357 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
358 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
359 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
360 % it needs to be
361 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
362 \shipout\vbox{%
363 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
364 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
366 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
367 \hsize = \outerhsize
368 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
369 \vtop to0pt{%
370 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
371 \nointerlineskip
372 \line{%
373 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
374 \hfill
375 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
377 \vss}%
378 \vskip\topandbottommargin
379 \line\bgroup
380 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
381 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
382 \vbox\bgroup
385 \unvbox\headlinebox
386 \pagebody{#1}%
387 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
388 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
389 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
390 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
391 \vskip 24pt
392 \unvbox\footlinebox
395 \ifcropmarks
396 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
397 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
398 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
399 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
400 \vbox to0pt{\vss
401 \line{%
402 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
403 \hfill
404 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
406 \nointerlineskip
407 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
409 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
411 }% end of \shipout\vbox
412 }% end of group with \indexdummies
413 \advancepageno
414 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
417 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
419 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
420 {\catcode`\@ =11
421 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
422 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
423 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
424 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
425 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
426 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
427 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
430 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
431 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
432 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
434 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
435 \def\nstop{\vbox
436 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
437 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
438 \def\nsbot{\vbox
439 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
441 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
442 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
443 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
445 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
446 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
447 \def\argtorun{#2}%
448 \begingroup
449 \obeylines
450 \spaceisspace
452 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
455 {\obeylines %
456 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
457 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
458 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
462 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
463 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
464 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
466 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
468 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
469 % @end itemize @c foo
470 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
471 % by \finishparsearg.
473 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
474 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
475 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
476 \def\temp{#3}%
477 \ifx\temp\empty
478 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
479 \let\temp\finishparsearg
480 \else
481 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
483 % Put the space token in:
484 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
487 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
488 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
489 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
490 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
491 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
492 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
493 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
495 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
497 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
499 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
500 % is roughly equivalent to
501 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
502 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
504 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
505 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
507 \def\parseargdef#1{%
508 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
510 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
511 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
512 \def#1##1%
515 % Several utility definitions with active space:
517 \obeyspaces
518 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
520 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
521 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
522 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
523 % should produce a line of output anyway.
525 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
527 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
528 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
529 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
530 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
534 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
536 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
538 % \envdef\foo{...}
539 % \def\Efoo{...}
541 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
542 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
543 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
544 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
545 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
547 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
548 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
549 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
550 % special case.)
553 % At run-time, environments start with this:
554 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
555 % initialize
556 \let\thisenv\empty
558 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
559 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
560 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
562 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
563 \def\checkenv#1{%
564 \def\temp{#1}%
565 \ifx\thisenv\temp
566 \else
567 \badenverr
571 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
572 \def\badenverr{%
573 \errhelp = \EMsimple
574 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
575 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
577 \def\inenvironment#1{%
578 \ifx#1\empty
579 out of any environment%
580 \else
581 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
585 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
586 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
588 \parseargdef\end{%
589 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
590 \else
591 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
592 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
593 \csname E#1\endcsname
594 \endgroup
598 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
601 %% Simple single-character @ commands
603 % @@ prints an @
604 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
605 \def\@{{\tt\char64}}
607 % This is turned off because it was never documented
608 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
609 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
610 %% but suppressing ligatures.
611 %\def\`{{`}}
612 %\def\'{{'}}
614 % Used to generate quoted braces.
615 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
616 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
617 \let\{=\mylbrace
618 \let\}=\myrbrace
619 \begingroup
620 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
621 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
622 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
623 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
624 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
625 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
626 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
627 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
628 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
629 !endgroup
631 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
632 \let\comma = ,
634 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
635 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
636 \let\, = \c
637 \let\dotaccent = \.
638 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
639 \let\tieaccent = \t
640 \let\ubaraccent = \b
641 \let\udotaccent = \d
643 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
644 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
645 \def\questiondown{?`}
646 \def\exclamdown{!`}
647 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
648 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
650 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
651 \def\imacro{i}
652 \def\jmacro{j}
653 \def\dotless#1{%
654 \def\temp{#1}%
655 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
656 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
657 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
658 \fi\fi
661 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
662 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
664 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
666 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
667 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
668 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
669 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
670 % \scriptscriptstyle).
672 \def\LaTeX{%
673 L\kern-.36em
674 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
675 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
676 \kern-.15em
677 \TeX
680 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
681 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
682 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
683 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
684 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
685 {\catcode`@ = 11
686 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
687 % if the definition is written into an index file.
688 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
689 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
692 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
693 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
695 % @* forces a line break.
696 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
698 % @/ allows a line break.
699 \let\/=\allowbreak
701 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
702 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
704 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
705 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
707 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
708 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
710 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
712 \def\onword{on}
713 \def\offword{off}
715 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
716 \def\temp{#1}%
717 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
718 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
719 \else
720 \errhelp = \EMsimple
721 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
722 \fi\fi
725 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
726 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
727 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
728 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
730 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
731 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
732 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
733 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
734 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
735 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
736 % the text is small, which looks bad.
738 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
739 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
740 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
741 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
742 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
743 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
745 \newbox\groupbox
746 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
748 \envdef\group{%
749 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
750 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
751 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
753 \startsavinginserts
755 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
756 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
757 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
758 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
759 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
760 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
761 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
762 \comment
765 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
766 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
767 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
768 % above. But it's pretty close.
769 \def\Egroup{%
770 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
771 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
772 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
773 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
774 \egroup % End the \vtop.
775 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
776 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
777 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
778 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
779 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
780 % group, force a page break.
781 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
782 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
783 \page
786 \box\groupbox
787 \prevdepth = \dimen1
788 \checkinserts
791 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
792 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
794 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
795 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
796 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
798 % @need space-in-mils
799 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
801 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
803 % Old definition--didn't work.
804 %\parseargdef\need{\par %
805 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
806 %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
807 %{\baselineskip=0pt%
808 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
809 %\prevdepth=-1000pt
812 \parseargdef\need{%
813 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
814 % paragraph.
815 \par
817 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
818 \dimen0 = #1\mil
819 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
820 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
821 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
823 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
824 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
825 % And a page break here is fine.
826 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
828 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
829 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
830 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
831 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
832 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
834 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
835 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
836 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
837 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
838 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
839 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
840 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
841 \penalty9999
843 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
844 \kern -#1\mil
846 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
847 \nobreak
851 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
853 \let\br = \par
855 % @page forces the start of a new page.
857 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
859 % @exdent text....
860 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
862 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
863 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
864 \newskip\exdentamount
866 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
867 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
869 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
870 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
871 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
873 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
874 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
875 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
877 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
878 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
880 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
881 \nobreak
882 \kern-\strutdepth
883 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
884 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
885 \vss
886 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
887 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
888 \ifx#1l%
889 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
890 \else
891 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
893 \null
896 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
897 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
899 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
900 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
901 % else use TEXT for both).
903 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
904 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
905 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
906 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
907 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
908 \def\righttext{#2}%
909 \else
910 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
911 \def\righttext{#1}%
914 \ifodd\pageno
915 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
916 \else
917 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
919 \temp
922 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
924 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
925 \def\includezzz#1{%
926 \pushthisfilestack
927 \def\thisfile{#1}%
929 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
930 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
931 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
932 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
934 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
935 % definitions, etc.
936 \expandafter
937 }\temp
938 \popthisfilestack
940 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
941 \catcode`\\=\other
942 \catcode`~=\other
943 \catcode`^=\other
944 \catcode`_=\other
945 \catcode`|=\other
946 \catcode`<=\other
947 \catcode`>=\other
948 \catcode`+=\other
949 \catcode`-=\other
950 \catcode`\`=\other
951 \catcode`\'=\other
954 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
955 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
957 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
958 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
960 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
961 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
964 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
965 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
966 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
968 \def\thisfile{}
970 % @center line
971 % outputs that line, centered.
973 \parseargdef\center{%
974 \ifhmode
975 \let\next\centerH
976 \else
977 \let\next\centerV
979 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
981 \def\centerH#1{%
983 \hfil\break
984 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
985 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
986 \line{#1}%
987 \break
990 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
992 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
994 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
996 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
997 % @c is the same as @comment
998 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
1000 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
1001 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
1002 \commentxxx}
1003 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
1005 \let\c=\comment
1007 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
1008 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
1009 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
1010 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
1012 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
1013 \def\noneword{none}
1015 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
1016 \def\temp{#1}%
1017 \ifx\temp\asisword
1018 \else
1019 \ifx\temp\noneword
1020 \defaultparindent = 0pt
1021 \else
1022 \defaultparindent = #1em
1025 \parindent = \defaultparindent
1028 % @exampleindent NCHARS
1029 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
1030 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
1031 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
1032 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
1033 \def\temp{#1}%
1034 \ifx\temp\asisword
1035 \else
1036 \ifx\temp\noneword
1037 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
1038 \else
1039 \lispnarrowing = #1em
1044 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
1045 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
1046 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
1047 % paragraphs.
1049 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
1050 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
1051 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
1052 % By default, we suppress indentation.
1054 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
1055 \def\insertword{insert}
1057 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
1058 \def\temp{#1}%
1059 \ifx\temp\noneword
1060 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
1061 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
1062 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
1063 \else
1064 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1065 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1066 \fi\fi
1069 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1070 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1072 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1073 % paragraph.
1075 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1076 \gdef\indent{%
1077 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1078 \indent
1080 \gdef\noindent{%
1081 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1082 \noindent
1084 \global\everypar = {%
1085 \kern -\parindent
1086 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1090 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1091 \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
1092 \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
1093 \global \everypar = {}%
1097 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
1099 \def\asis#1{#1}
1101 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
1103 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
1104 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
1105 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
1106 % which is what @var uses.
1108 \catcode`\_ = \active
1109 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
1110 \catcode`\_=\active
1111 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
1114 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
1115 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
1116 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
1117 % otherwise define @\.
1119 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
1120 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
1122 \def\math{%
1123 \tex
1124 \mathunderscore
1125 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
1126 \mathactive
1127 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
1128 \let\"=\ddot
1129 \let\'=\acute
1130 \let\==\bar
1131 \let\^=\hat
1132 \let\`=\grave
1133 \let\u=\breve
1134 \let\v=\check
1135 \let\~=\tilde
1136 \let\dotaccent=\dot
1137 $\finishmath
1139 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
1141 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
1142 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
1143 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
1146 \catcode`^ = \active
1147 \catcode`< = \active
1148 \catcode`> = \active
1149 \catcode`+ = \active
1150 \catcode`' = \active
1151 \gdef\mathactive{%
1152 \let^ = \ptexhat
1153 \let< = \ptexless
1154 \let> = \ptexgtr
1155 \let+ = \ptexplus
1156 \let' = \ptexquoteright
1160 % Some math mode symbols.
1161 \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
1162 \def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $\ge$\fi}
1163 \def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $\le$\fi}
1164 \def\minus{\ifmmode -\else $-$\fi}
1166 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
1167 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
1168 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
1169 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
1170 % whichever is larger.
1172 \def\dots{%
1173 \leavevmode
1174 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
1175 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
1176 \dimen0 = \wd0
1177 \else
1178 \dimen0 = 1.5em
1180 \hbox to \dimen0{%
1181 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
1182 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1183 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
1184 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
1188 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
1190 \def\enddots{%
1191 \dots
1192 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
1195 % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
1196 % Texinfo's parsing.
1198 \let\comma = ,
1200 % @refill is a no-op.
1201 \let\refill=\relax
1203 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1204 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1205 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1207 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1208 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
1210 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1211 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1212 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1213 \def\setfilename{%
1214 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1215 \iflinks
1216 \tryauxfile
1217 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1218 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
1219 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1220 \openindices
1221 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1223 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1224 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1225 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1226 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
1227 \closein 1
1229 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1232 % Called from \setfilename.
1234 \def\openindices{%
1235 \newindex{cp}%
1236 \newcodeindex{fn}%
1237 \newcodeindex{vr}%
1238 \newcodeindex{tp}%
1239 \newcodeindex{ky}%
1240 \newcodeindex{pg}%
1243 % @bye.
1244 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1247 \message{pdf,}
1248 % adobe `portable' document format
1249 \newcount\tempnum
1250 \newcount\lnkcount
1251 \newtoks\filename
1252 \newcount\filenamelength
1253 \newcount\pgn
1254 \newtoks\toksA
1255 \newtoks\toksB
1256 \newtoks\toksC
1257 \newtoks\toksD
1258 \newbox\boxA
1259 \newcount\countA
1260 \newif\ifpdf
1261 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1263 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1264 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
1265 % borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
1266 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
1267 \else
1268 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1269 \else
1270 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1271 \else
1272 \pdftrue
1277 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1278 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1279 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1280 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1281 % http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
1282 % (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
1283 % user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1284 % that's what we do).
1286 % double active backslashes.
1288 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
1289 @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
1290 @catcode`@\=@active
1291 @let\=@doublebackslash}
1294 % To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
1295 % not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
1296 % us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens, with minor
1297 % changes for Texinfo. It is included here under the GPL by permission
1298 % from the author, Heiko Oberdiek.
1300 % #1 is the tokens to replace.
1301 % #2 is the replacement.
1302 % #3 is the control sequence with the string.
1304 \def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
1305 \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
1306 ##1%
1307 \ifx\\##2\\%
1308 \else
1310 \HyReturnAfterFi{%
1311 \HyPsdReplace##2\END
1315 \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
1317 \long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
1319 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
1320 \def\backslashparens#1{%
1321 \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
1322 % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
1323 \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
1324 \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
1327 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1328 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1329 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1330 output) for that.)}
1332 \ifpdf
1334 % Color manipulation macros based on pdfcolor.tex.
1335 \def\cmykDarkRed{0.28 1 1 0.35}
1336 \def\cmykBlack{0 0 0 1}
1338 % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1339 % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1340 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 k #1 K}}
1342 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1343 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1344 \def\setcolor#1{%
1345 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1346 \domark
1347 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1350 \def\maincolor{\cmykBlack}
1351 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1352 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1353 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1355 \def\makefootline{%
1356 \baselineskip24pt
1357 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1360 \def\makeheadline{%
1361 \vbox to 0pt{%
1362 \vskip-22.5pt
1363 \line{%
1364 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1365 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1366 \getcolormarks
1367 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1368 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1370 \vss
1372 \nointerlineskip
1376 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1378 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1379 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1380 \def\imagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1381 \def\imageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1383 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .png, .jpg, .pdf (among
1384 % others). Let's try in that order.
1385 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1386 \begingroup
1387 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1388 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1389 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1390 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1391 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1392 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1393 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1394 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1395 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
1397 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1399 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1401 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1403 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1405 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1407 \closein 1
1408 \endgroup
1410 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1411 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1412 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1413 \immediate\pdfimage
1414 \else
1415 \immediate\pdfximage
1417 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \imagewidth \fi
1418 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \imageheight \fi
1419 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1420 #1.\pdfimgext
1421 \else
1422 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1424 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1425 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1426 \fi}
1428 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
1429 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1430 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1431 \indexnofonts
1432 \turnoffactive
1433 \activebackslashdouble
1434 \makevalueexpandable
1435 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1436 \backslashparens\pdfdestname
1437 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1440 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1441 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1443 % by default, use a color that is dark enough to print on paper as
1444 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing.
1445 \def\urlcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
1446 \def\linkcolor{\cmykDarkRed}
1447 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1449 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1450 % come from Petr Olsak
1451 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1452 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1453 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1454 \advance\tempnum by 1
1455 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1457 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1458 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1459 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1460 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1461 % #4 is the page number
1463 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1464 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1465 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1466 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1467 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1468 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1469 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1470 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1471 \else
1472 % Doubled backslashes in the name.
1473 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1474 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
1477 % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
1478 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1479 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
1481 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1484 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1485 \begingroup
1486 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
1487 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
1488 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
1490 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1491 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1492 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1493 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1494 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1496 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1497 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1498 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1499 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1501 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1502 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1503 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1505 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1506 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1508 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1509 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1510 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1512 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1513 % al. a second time, below.
1514 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1515 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1516 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1517 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1518 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1519 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1520 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1521 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1522 \readdatafile{toc}%
1524 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1525 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1526 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1528 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1529 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1530 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1531 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1532 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1533 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1534 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1535 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1536 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1538 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1539 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1540 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1541 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1542 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1544 % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1545 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
1546 % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
1547 \indexnofonts
1548 \setupdatafile
1549 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1550 \input \tocreadfilename
1551 \endgroup
1554 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1555 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1556 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1557 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1558 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1561 \nextsp}
1562 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
1563 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1564 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1565 \else
1566 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1568 % make a live url in pdf output.
1569 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1570 \begingroup
1571 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1572 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1573 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1574 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1576 \normalturnoffactive
1577 \def\@{@}%
1578 \let\/=\empty
1579 \makevalueexpandable
1580 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1581 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1582 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1583 \endgroup}
1584 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1585 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1586 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1587 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1588 \def\maketoks{%
1589 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1590 \ifx\first0\adn0
1591 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1592 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1593 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1594 \else
1595 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1596 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1597 \let\next=\maketoks
1598 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1599 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1601 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1602 \next}
1603 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1604 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1605 \def\pdflink#1{%
1606 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1607 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1608 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1609 \else
1610 % non-pdf mode
1611 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1612 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1613 \let\endlink = \relax
1614 \let\setcolor = \gobble
1615 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
1616 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1617 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1620 \message{fonts,}
1622 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1623 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1624 % italics, not bold italics.
1626 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1627 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1628 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
1631 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1633 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1635 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
1636 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
1637 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
1638 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
1639 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
1641 % Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since
1642 % in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh.
1643 \def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}}
1645 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1646 % So we set up a \sf.
1647 \newfam\sffam
1648 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
1649 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1651 % We don't need math for this font style.
1652 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
1655 % Default leading.
1656 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
1658 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1659 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1660 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1662 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1663 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1664 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1666 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1667 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1669 \def\setleading#1{%
1670 \dimen0 = #1\relax
1671 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
1672 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1673 \normalbaselines
1674 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1675 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1676 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1680 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1682 % do nothing with this by default.
1683 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1684 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1685 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1687 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1688 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1689 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1690 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\undefined \else
1691 \begingroup
1692 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1693 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1694 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1695 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1696 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1697 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1698 %%Version: 1.000
1699 %%EndComments
1700 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1701 12 dict begin
1702 begincmap
1703 /CIDSystemInfo
1704 << /Registry (TeX)
1705 /Ordering (OT1)
1706 /Supplement 0
1707 >> def
1708 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1709 /CMapType 2 def
1710 1 begincodespacerange
1711 <00> <7F>
1712 endcodespacerange
1713 8 beginbfrange
1714 <00> <01> <0393>
1715 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1716 <23> <26> <0023>
1717 <28> <3B> <0028>
1718 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1719 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1720 <61> <7A> <0061>
1721 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1722 endbfrange
1723 40 beginbfchar
1724 <02> <0398>
1725 <03> <039B>
1726 <04> <039E>
1727 <05> <03A0>
1728 <06> <03A3>
1729 <07> <03D2>
1730 <08> <03A6>
1731 <0B> <00660066>
1732 <0C> <00660069>
1733 <0D> <0066006C>
1734 <0E> <006600660069>
1735 <0F> <00660066006C>
1736 <10> <0131>
1737 <11> <0237>
1738 <12> <0060>
1739 <13> <00B4>
1740 <14> <02C7>
1741 <15> <02D8>
1742 <16> <00AF>
1743 <17> <02DA>
1744 <18> <00B8>
1745 <19> <00DF>
1746 <1A> <00E6>
1747 <1B> <0153>
1748 <1C> <00F8>
1749 <1D> <00C6>
1750 <1E> <0152>
1751 <1F> <00D8>
1752 <21> <0021>
1753 <22> <201D>
1754 <27> <2019>
1755 <3C> <00A1>
1756 <3D> <003D>
1757 <3E> <00BF>
1758 <5C> <201C>
1759 <5F> <02D9>
1760 <60> <2018>
1761 <7D> <02DD>
1762 <7E> <007E>
1763 <7F> <00A8>
1764 endbfchar
1765 endcmap
1766 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1769 %%EndResource
1770 %%EOF
1771 }\endgroup
1772 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1773 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1776 % \cmapOT1IT
1777 \begingroup
1778 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1779 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1780 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1781 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1782 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1783 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1784 %%Version: 1.000
1785 %%EndComments
1786 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1787 12 dict begin
1788 begincmap
1789 /CIDSystemInfo
1790 << /Registry (TeX)
1791 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1792 /Supplement 0
1793 >> def
1794 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
1795 /CMapType 2 def
1796 1 begincodespacerange
1797 <00> <7F>
1798 endcodespacerange
1799 8 beginbfrange
1800 <00> <01> <0393>
1801 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1802 <25> <26> <0025>
1803 <28> <3B> <0028>
1804 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1805 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1806 <61> <7A> <0061>
1807 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1808 endbfrange
1809 42 beginbfchar
1810 <02> <0398>
1811 <03> <039B>
1812 <04> <039E>
1813 <05> <03A0>
1814 <06> <03A3>
1815 <07> <03D2>
1816 <08> <03A6>
1817 <0B> <00660066>
1818 <0C> <00660069>
1819 <0D> <0066006C>
1820 <0E> <006600660069>
1821 <0F> <00660066006C>
1822 <10> <0131>
1823 <11> <0237>
1824 <12> <0060>
1825 <13> <00B4>
1826 <14> <02C7>
1827 <15> <02D8>
1828 <16> <00AF>
1829 <17> <02DA>
1830 <18> <00B8>
1831 <19> <00DF>
1832 <1A> <00E6>
1833 <1B> <0153>
1834 <1C> <00F8>
1835 <1D> <00C6>
1836 <1E> <0152>
1837 <1F> <00D8>
1838 <21> <0021>
1839 <22> <201D>
1840 <23> <0023>
1841 <24> <00A3>
1842 <27> <2019>
1843 <3C> <00A1>
1844 <3D> <003D>
1845 <3E> <00BF>
1846 <5C> <201C>
1847 <5F> <02D9>
1848 <60> <2018>
1849 <7D> <02DD>
1850 <7E> <007E>
1851 <7F> <00A8>
1852 endbfchar
1853 endcmap
1854 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1857 %%EndResource
1858 %%EOF
1859 }\endgroup
1860 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
1861 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1864 % \cmapOT1TT
1865 \begingroup
1866 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1867 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1868 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1869 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1870 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1871 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1872 %%Version: 1.000
1873 %%EndComments
1874 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1875 12 dict begin
1876 begincmap
1877 /CIDSystemInfo
1878 << /Registry (TeX)
1879 /Ordering (OT1TT)
1880 /Supplement 0
1881 >> def
1882 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
1883 /CMapType 2 def
1884 1 begincodespacerange
1885 <00> <7F>
1886 endcodespacerange
1887 5 beginbfrange
1888 <00> <01> <0393>
1889 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1890 <21> <26> <0021>
1891 <28> <5F> <0028>
1892 <61> <7E> <0061>
1893 endbfrange
1894 32 beginbfchar
1895 <02> <0398>
1896 <03> <039B>
1897 <04> <039E>
1898 <05> <03A0>
1899 <06> <03A3>
1900 <07> <03D2>
1901 <08> <03A6>
1902 <0B> <2191>
1903 <0C> <2193>
1904 <0D> <0027>
1905 <0E> <00A1>
1906 <0F> <00BF>
1907 <10> <0131>
1908 <11> <0237>
1909 <12> <0060>
1910 <13> <00B4>
1911 <14> <02C7>
1912 <15> <02D8>
1913 <16> <00AF>
1914 <17> <02DA>
1915 <18> <00B8>
1916 <19> <00DF>
1917 <1A> <00E6>
1918 <1B> <0153>
1919 <1C> <00F8>
1920 <1D> <00C6>
1921 <1E> <0152>
1922 <1F> <00D8>
1923 <20> <2423>
1924 <27> <2019>
1925 <60> <2018>
1926 <7F> <00A8>
1927 endbfchar
1928 endcmap
1929 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1932 %%EndResource
1933 %%EOF
1934 }\endgroup
1935 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
1936 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1938 \fi\fi
1941 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
1942 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
1943 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1944 % encoding (currently only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, pass
1945 % empty to omit).
1946 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1947 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
1948 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
1950 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1951 \let\cmap\gobble
1952 % emacs-page end of cmaps
1954 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1955 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1956 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1957 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined
1958 \def\fontprefix{cm}
1960 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1961 \def\rmshape{r}
1962 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
1963 \def\bfshape{b}
1964 \def\bxshape{bx}
1965 \def\ttshape{tt}
1966 \def\ttbshape{tt}
1967 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
1968 \def\itshape{ti}
1969 \def\itbshape{bxti}
1970 \def\slshape{sl}
1971 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
1972 \def\sfshape{ss}
1973 \def\sfbshape{ss}
1974 \def\scshape{csc}
1975 \def\scbshape{csc}
1977 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. This is the default in
1978 % Texinfo.
1980 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1981 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1982 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
1983 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1984 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1985 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1986 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1987 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1988 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1989 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1990 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1991 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1992 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1993 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1994 \def\textecsize{1095}
1996 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1997 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1998 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1999 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2000 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
2002 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2003 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2004 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2005 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2006 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2007 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2008 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2009 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2010 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2011 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2012 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2013 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2014 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2016 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2017 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2018 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2019 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2020 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2021 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2022 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2023 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2024 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2025 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2026 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2027 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2028 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2030 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2031 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2032 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2033 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2034 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2035 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2036 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2037 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2038 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2039 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2040 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2041 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2042 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2044 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
2045 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
2046 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2047 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
2048 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2049 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2050 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2051 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
2052 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
2053 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2054 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
2055 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
2056 \def\chapecsize{1728}
2058 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
2059 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
2060 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2061 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2062 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2063 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2064 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2065 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2066 \let\secbf\secrm
2067 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2068 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2069 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2070 \def\sececsize{1440}
2072 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
2073 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
2074 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2075 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
2076 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2077 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2078 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
2079 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2080 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2081 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
2082 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
2083 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
2084 \def\ssececsize{1200}
2086 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
2087 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
2088 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2089 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2090 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2091 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2092 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2093 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2094 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2095 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2096 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
2097 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
2098 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
2100 % reset the current fonts
2101 \textfonts
2103 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions
2106 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
2107 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
2108 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
2109 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
2111 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
2112 % Text fonts (10pt).
2113 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
2114 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
2115 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2116 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2117 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2118 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
2119 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2120 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2121 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
2122 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
2123 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
2124 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
2125 \def\textecsize{1000}
2127 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
2128 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
2129 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2130 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
2131 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
2133 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
2134 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
2135 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2136 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2137 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2138 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2139 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2140 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2141 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2142 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2143 \font\smalli=cmmi9
2144 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
2145 \def\smallecsize{0900}
2147 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
2148 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
2149 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2150 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
2151 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2152 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
2153 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2154 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2155 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
2156 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
2157 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
2158 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
2159 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
2161 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
2162 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
2163 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
2164 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
2165 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2166 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
2167 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
2168 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2169 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2170 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2171 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2172 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2173 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2175 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2176 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2177 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2178 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2179 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2180 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2181 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2182 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2183 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2184 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2185 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2186 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2187 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2189 % Section fonts (12pt).
2190 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2191 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2192 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2193 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2194 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2195 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2196 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2197 \let\secbf\secrm
2198 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2199 \font\seci=cmmi12
2200 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2201 \def\sececsize{1200}
2203 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2204 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2205 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2206 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2207 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2208 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2209 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2210 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2211 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2212 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2213 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2214 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2215 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2217 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2218 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2219 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2220 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2221 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2222 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2223 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2224 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2225 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2226 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2227 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2228 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2229 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2231 % reduce space between paragraphs
2232 \divide\parskip by 2
2234 % reset the current fonts
2235 \textfonts
2237 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions
2240 % We provide the user-level command
2241 % @fonttextsize 10
2242 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2244 \def\xword{10}
2245 \def\xiword{11}
2247 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2248 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2249 \wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2251 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2252 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2254 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2255 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2256 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2257 \else
2258 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2259 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2260 \fi\fi
2261 \endgroup
2265 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2266 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
2267 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
2268 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
2269 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
2271 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2272 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
2273 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
2274 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
2277 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2278 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2279 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2280 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2282 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2283 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
2284 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2286 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2288 \def\textfonts{%
2289 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
2290 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
2291 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
2292 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
2293 \def\curfontsize{text}%
2294 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2295 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2296 \def\titlefonts{%
2297 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
2298 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
2299 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
2300 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
2301 \def\curfontsize{title}%
2302 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
2303 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
2304 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}}
2305 \def\chapfonts{%
2306 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
2307 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
2308 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
2309 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
2310 \def\curfontsize{chap}%
2311 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
2312 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
2313 \def\secfonts{%
2314 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
2315 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
2316 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
2317 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
2318 \def\curfontsize{sec}%
2319 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
2320 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
2321 \def\subsecfonts{%
2322 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
2323 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
2324 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
2325 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
2326 \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
2327 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
2328 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
2329 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
2330 \def\reducedfonts{%
2331 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
2332 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
2333 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
2334 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
2335 \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
2336 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2337 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2338 \def\smallfonts{%
2339 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
2340 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
2341 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
2342 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
2343 \def\curfontsize{small}%
2344 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2345 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2346 \def\smallerfonts{%
2347 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
2348 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
2349 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
2350 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
2351 \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
2352 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2353 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
2355 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2356 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2357 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2358 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2359 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2361 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2362 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2363 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2365 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2366 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2368 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2369 % can fit this many characters:
2370 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2371 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2372 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2373 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2374 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2376 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2377 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2378 % --karl, 24jan03.
2380 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2382 \definetextfontsizexi
2385 \message{markup,}
2387 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2388 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2389 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2390 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2392 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2394 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2395 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2396 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2397 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
2398 % currently in effect.
2399 \newif\ifmarkupvar
2400 \newif\ifmarkupsamp
2401 \newif\ifmarkupkey
2402 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
2403 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
2404 \newif\ifmarkupcode
2405 \newif\ifmarkupkbd
2406 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
2407 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
2408 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
2409 \newif\ifmarkupexample
2410 \newif\ifmarkupverb
2411 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim
2413 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2415 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2416 \csname markup#1true\endcsname
2417 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2418 \markupstylesetup
2421 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2423 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2424 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2425 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2426 \def#1%
2429 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2430 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2431 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2432 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2435 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2436 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2437 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2441 \catcode`\'=\active
2442 \catcode`\`=\active
2444 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
2445 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
2447 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
2448 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
2450 \gdef\markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft{\let`\noligaturesquoteleft}
2453 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2454 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2455 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2456 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2457 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2458 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2459 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2460 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2462 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft
2463 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetnoligaturesquoteleft
2465 % Allow an option to not replace quotes with a regular directed right
2466 % quote/apostrophe (char 0x27), but instead use the undirected quote
2467 % from cmtt (char 0x0d). The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it
2468 % the default, but it works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least
2469 % evince), the lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the
2470 % regular 0x27.
2472 \def\codequoteright{%
2473 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2474 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2476 \else \char'15 \fi
2477 \else \char'15 \fi
2480 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2481 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2482 % the code environments to do likewise.
2484 \def\codequoteleft{%
2485 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2486 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2487 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2488 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2489 \relax`%
2490 \else \char'22 \fi
2491 \else \char'22 \fi
2494 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2495 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2497 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2498 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2500 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
2501 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
2503 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
2504 % unless the following character is such as not to need one.
2505 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
2506 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
2507 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2508 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2510 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
2511 % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
2512 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2514 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2515 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2516 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
2518 \let\i=\smartitalic
2519 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2520 \def\var#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\smartslanted{#1}}}
2521 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2522 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2524 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2525 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2526 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2527 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2529 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2530 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2531 \let\strong=\b
2533 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2534 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2536 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2537 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2538 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2540 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2541 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2543 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2544 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2545 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2547 \catcode`@=11
2548 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2549 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2550 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2551 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2553 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2554 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2555 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2556 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2558 \catcode`@=\other
2559 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2561 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2562 \def\t#1{%
2563 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2564 \null
2567 % @samp.
2568 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2570 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
2571 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2572 %\font\keysy=cmsy9
2573 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2574 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
2575 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
2576 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2577 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
2578 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2580 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
2581 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
2582 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
2584 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}
2585 \nohyphenation
2586 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
2587 #1}\null}
2589 % ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command.
2590 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2592 % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
2593 \let\file=\samp
2594 \let\option=\samp
2596 % @code is a modification of @t,
2597 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
2598 \def\tclose#1{%
2600 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2601 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2603 % Switch to typewriter.
2606 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2607 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2609 % Turn off hyphenation.
2610 \nohyphenation
2612 \rawbackslash
2613 \plainfrenchspacing
2616 \null
2619 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2620 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2621 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2623 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2624 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2625 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2626 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
2627 % -- rms.
2629 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2630 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2631 \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
2633 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2634 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2635 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2636 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2637 \ifallowcodebreaks
2638 \let-\codedash
2639 \let_\codeunder
2640 \else
2641 \let-\realdash
2642 \let_\realunder
2644 \codex
2648 \def\realdash{-}
2649 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
2650 \def\codeunder{%
2651 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2652 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2653 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2654 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2655 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2656 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2657 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2658 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2659 {\_}%
2661 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2663 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2664 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
2665 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
2666 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
2668 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2670 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2671 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2673 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2674 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2675 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2676 \allowcodebreakstrue
2677 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2678 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2679 \else
2680 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2681 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
2682 \fi\fi
2685 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2686 % then @kbd has no effect.
2687 \def\kbd#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}}
2689 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2690 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2691 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2692 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2693 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2694 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2695 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2696 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2697 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2698 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2699 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2700 \else
2701 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2702 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
2703 \fi\fi\fi
2705 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
2706 \def\wordexample{example}
2707 \def\wordcode{code}
2709 % Default is `distinct'.
2710 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2712 \def\xkey{\key}
2713 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
2714 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2715 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
2716 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi}
2718 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
2719 \let\indicateurl=\code
2720 \let\env=\code
2721 \let\command=\code
2723 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
2724 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
2726 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
2727 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
2728 \def\click{\arrow}
2730 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
2731 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
2732 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
2733 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
2734 % a hypertex \special here.
2736 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
2737 \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
2738 \unsepspaces
2739 \pdfurl{#1}%
2740 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2741 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2742 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2743 \else
2744 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2745 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2746 \ifpdf
2747 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
2748 \else
2749 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
2751 \else
2752 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
2755 \endlink
2756 \endgroup}
2758 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2760 \let\url=\uref
2762 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2763 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2765 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2766 \ifpdf
2767 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
2768 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
2769 \unsepspaces
2770 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
2771 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2772 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2773 \endlink
2774 \endgroup}
2775 \else
2776 \let\email=\uref
2779 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2780 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2782 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2784 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2785 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2786 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2787 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2789 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2790 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2791 % all-uppercase.
2793 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
2794 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2795 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2796 \def\temp{#2}%
2797 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2798 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2802 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2803 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2805 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
2806 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2807 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2808 \def\temp{#2}%
2809 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2810 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2815 \message{glyphs,}
2817 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
2819 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
2820 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
2822 \def\point{$\star$}
2823 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
2824 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
2825 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
2826 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
2827 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
2829 % The @error{} command.
2830 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
2832 \newbox\errorbox
2834 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
2835 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
2836 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
2837 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf error\kern-1.5pt}
2839 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
2840 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
2841 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
2842 \vbox{%
2843 \hrule height\dimen2
2844 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
2845 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
2846 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
2847 \hrule height\dimen2}
2848 \hfil}
2850 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
2852 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
2854 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
2856 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
2857 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
2858 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
2859 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
2860 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
2862 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
2863 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
2864 % font height.
2866 % feymr - regular
2867 % feymo - slanted
2868 % feybr - bold
2869 % feybo - bold slanted
2871 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
2872 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
2873 % Hmm.
2875 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
2876 % Hope not.
2879 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
2880 \def\eurofont{%
2881 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
2882 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
2883 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
2884 % font installed.
2886 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
2887 % that to the current nominal size.
2889 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
2890 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
2892 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
2894 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2895 % bold:
2896 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
2897 \else
2898 % regular:
2899 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
2901 \thiseurofont
2904 % Hacks for glyphs from the EC fonts similar to \euro. We don't
2905 % use \let for the aliases, because sometimes we redefine the original
2906 % macro, and the alias should reflect the redefinition.
2907 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
2908 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
2909 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
2910 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
2911 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
2912 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
2913 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
2914 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
2916 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
2917 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
2918 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
2919 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
2921 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
2922 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
2923 % the same EC font.
2924 \def\ogonek#1{{%
2925 \def\temp{#1}%
2926 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
2927 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
2928 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
2929 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
2930 \else
2931 \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
2932 \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
2933 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
2935 \fi\fi\fi\fi
2938 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
2939 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
2940 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
2941 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
2943 \def\ecfont{%
2944 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
2945 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
2946 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
2947 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
2948 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
2949 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
2950 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2951 % bold:
2952 \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
2953 \else
2954 % regular:
2955 \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
2957 \thisecfont
2960 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
2961 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
2962 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
2964 \def\registeredsymbol{%
2965 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
2966 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
2970 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
2972 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
2974 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
2975 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
2976 % so we'll define it if necessary.
2978 \ifx\Orb\undefined
2979 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
2982 % Quotes.
2983 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C
2984 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
2985 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
2986 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
2989 \message{page headings,}
2991 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
2992 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
2994 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
2995 \newif\ifseenauthor
2996 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
2998 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
2999 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
3001 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3002 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3003 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3004 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3006 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3007 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3009 \envdef\titlepage{%
3010 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3011 \begingroup
3012 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
3013 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3014 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3015 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3016 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3018 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3019 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3020 \let\oldpage = \page
3021 \def\page{%
3022 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3023 \finishtitlepage
3025 \let\page = \oldpage
3026 \page
3027 \null
3031 \def\Etitlepage{%
3032 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3033 \finishtitlepage
3035 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3036 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3037 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3038 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3039 \oldpage
3040 \endgroup
3042 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3043 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3044 \HEADINGSon
3046 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
3047 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3048 \shortcontents
3049 \contents
3050 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
3051 \global\let\contents = \relax
3054 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3055 \contents
3056 \global\let\contents = \relax
3057 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
3061 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3062 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
3063 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3064 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3067 %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3069 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
3070 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
3072 \parseargdef\title{%
3073 \checkenv\titlepage
3074 \leftline{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}
3075 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3076 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3077 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
3080 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3081 \checkenv\titlepage
3082 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3085 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3086 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3088 \parseargdef\author{%
3089 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3090 \ifx\thisenv\temp
3091 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3092 \else
3093 \checkenv\titlepage
3094 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
3095 {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}%
3100 %%% Set up page headings and footings.
3102 \let\thispage=\folio
3104 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3105 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3106 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3107 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3109 % Now make TeX use those variables
3110 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3111 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3112 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3113 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3114 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
3116 % Commands to set those variables.
3117 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3118 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3119 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3120 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3121 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3124 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3125 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3126 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3127 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3129 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3130 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3131 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3132 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3134 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3136 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3137 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3138 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3139 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3141 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3142 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3143 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3144 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3146 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3147 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3148 \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
3149 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
3152 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3154 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3155 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3157 % The same set of arguments for:
3159 % @oddheadingmarks
3160 % @evenfootingmarks
3161 % @oddfootingmarks
3162 % @everyheadingmarks
3163 % @everyfootingmarks
3165 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
3166 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
3167 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
3168 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
3169 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
3170 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
3171 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
3172 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
3173 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3174 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3175 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
3176 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
3179 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3180 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3182 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3183 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3184 % @headings off turns them off.
3185 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3186 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3187 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3188 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3189 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3190 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3192 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
3194 \def\HEADINGSoff{%
3195 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3196 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
3197 \HEADINGSoff
3198 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3199 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3200 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3201 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3202 % edge of all pages.
3203 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3204 \global\pageno=1
3205 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3206 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3207 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3208 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3209 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3211 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3213 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3214 % page number on top right.
3215 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3216 \global\pageno=1
3217 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3218 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3219 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3220 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3221 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3223 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3225 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
3226 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
3227 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3228 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3229 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3230 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3231 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3232 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3235 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
3236 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3237 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3238 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3239 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3240 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3241 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3244 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3245 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3246 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3247 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3248 \ifx\today\undefined
3249 \def\today{%
3250 \number\day\space
3251 \ifcase\month
3252 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3253 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3254 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3256 \space\number\year}
3259 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3260 % It generates no output of its own.
3261 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3262 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3265 \message{tables,}
3266 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3268 % default indentation of table text
3269 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
3270 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3271 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
3272 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3273 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
3275 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3276 \newdimen\itemmax
3278 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3279 % these defs.
3280 % They also define \itemindex
3281 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3283 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3285 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3287 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3288 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3290 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3291 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
3292 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
3293 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3294 \itemindex{#1}%
3295 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3297 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3298 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3299 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3300 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3301 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3302 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
3304 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3305 % but leave it ragged-right.
3306 \begingroup
3307 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
3308 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
3309 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
3310 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3311 \endgroup
3313 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3314 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3315 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
3317 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3318 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3319 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3320 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3321 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3322 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3324 \penalty 10001
3325 \endgroup
3326 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3327 \else
3328 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3329 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3330 \noindent
3331 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3332 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3333 % eventually be printed.
3334 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
3335 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
3336 \unhbox0
3337 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
3338 \endgroup
3339 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
3343 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
3344 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
3346 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
3347 \envdef\table{%
3348 \let\itemindex\gobble
3349 \tablecheck{table}%
3351 \envdef\ftable{%
3352 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
3353 \tablecheck{ftable}%
3355 \envdef\vtable{%
3356 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
3357 \tablecheck{vtable}%
3359 \def\tablecheck#1{%
3360 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
3361 \endgroup
3362 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
3363 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
3364 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
3365 \else
3366 \let\next\tablex
3368 \next
3370 \def\tablex#1{%
3371 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
3372 \parsearg\tabley
3374 \def\tabley#1{%
3376 \makevalueexpandable
3377 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
3378 \expandafter
3379 }\temp \endtablez
3381 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3382 \aboveenvbreak
3383 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
3384 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
3385 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
3386 \itemmax=\tableindent
3387 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
3388 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
3389 \exdentamount=\tableindent
3390 \parindent = 0pt
3391 \parskip = \smallskipamount
3392 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3393 \let\item = \internalBitem
3394 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
3396 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3397 \let\Eftable\Etable
3398 \let\Evtable\Etable
3399 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3400 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3402 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3404 \newcount \itemno
3406 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3408 \def\doitemize#1{%
3409 \aboveenvbreak
3410 \itemmax=\itemindent
3411 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
3412 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
3413 \exdentamount=\itemindent
3414 \parindent=0pt
3415 \parskip=\smallskipamount
3416 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3417 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3418 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3419 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3420 \let\item=\itemizeitem
3423 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3425 \def\itemizeitem{%
3426 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
3427 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3429 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3430 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3431 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3432 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3433 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3434 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3435 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3436 % that's the theory.
3437 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
3438 \noindent
3439 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3440 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3441 \flushcr
3444 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3445 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3447 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3449 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3450 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3451 % argument is the same as `1'.
3453 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3454 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3455 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3456 \def\thearg{#1}%
3457 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3459 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3460 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3461 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3462 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3463 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3464 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3465 \ifx\rest\empty
3466 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3467 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3468 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3469 % not equal to itself.
3470 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3472 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3473 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3475 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
3476 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3477 \else
3478 % It's a letter.
3479 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
3480 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3481 \else
3482 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3485 \else
3486 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3487 \numericenumerate
3491 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3492 % given in \thearg.
3494 \def\numericenumerate{%
3495 \itemno = \thearg
3496 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3499 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3500 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3501 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3502 \startenumeration{%
3503 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3504 \ifnum\itemno=0
3505 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3506 alphabet}%
3508 \char\lccode\itemno
3512 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3513 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3514 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3515 \startenumeration{%
3516 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3517 \ifnum\itemno=0
3518 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3519 alphabet}
3521 \char\uccode\itemno
3525 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3526 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3527 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3529 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3530 \advance\itemno by -1
3531 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
3534 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3535 % to @enumerate.
3537 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
3538 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
3539 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3540 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3543 % @multitable macros
3544 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3546 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3547 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3548 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3549 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3551 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3553 % To make preamble:
3555 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3556 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3557 % @item ...
3559 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3560 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3561 % columns as desired.
3564 % Or use a template:
3565 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3566 % @item ...
3567 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3569 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3570 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3571 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3572 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3574 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3575 % if they are.
3577 % Sample multitable:
3579 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3580 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3581 % @item
3582 % first col stuff
3583 % @tab
3584 % second col stuff
3585 % @tab
3586 % third col
3587 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3588 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3590 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3591 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3592 % @end multitable
3594 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3595 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3596 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3597 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3598 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3599 % to baseline.
3600 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3602 \newskip\multitableparskip
3603 \newskip\multitableparindent
3604 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3605 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3606 \multitableparskip=0pt
3607 \multitableparindent=6pt
3608 \multitablecolspace=12pt
3609 \multitablelinespace=0pt
3611 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3613 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3614 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3615 \let\columnfractions\relax
3616 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3617 \newif\ifsetpercent
3619 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3620 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3622 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3623 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3624 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3625 \setuptable
3628 \newcount\colcount
3629 \def\setuptable#1{%
3630 \def\firstarg{#1}%
3631 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3632 \let\go = \relax
3633 \else
3634 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3635 \global\setpercenttrue
3636 \else
3637 \ifsetpercent
3638 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3639 \else
3640 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3641 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3642 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3643 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3646 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3647 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3648 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3649 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3650 \else
3651 \let\go = \setuptable
3652 \fi%
3657 % multitable-only commands.
3659 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
3660 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
3661 % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
3662 \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
3664 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3665 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3666 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
3667 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3668 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
3670 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3672 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3674 \envdef\multitable{%
3675 \vskip\parskip
3676 \startsavinginserts
3678 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3679 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3680 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3681 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3682 \def\item{\crcr}%
3684 \tolerance=9500
3685 \hbadness=9500
3686 \setmultitablespacing
3687 \parskip=\multitableparskip
3688 \parindent=\multitableparindent
3689 \overfullrule=0pt
3690 \global\colcount=0
3692 \everycr = {%
3693 \noalign{%
3694 \global\everytab={}%
3695 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
3696 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
3697 \checkinserts
3698 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
3699 %\filbreak
3700 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
3701 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
3702 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
3706 \parsearg\domultitable
3708 \def\domultitable#1{%
3709 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
3710 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
3712 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
3713 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
3714 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
3715 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
3716 \halign\bgroup &%
3717 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3718 \multistrut
3719 \vtop{%
3720 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
3721 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
3723 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
3724 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
3725 % the first one.
3727 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
3728 % to the width of each template entry.
3730 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
3731 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
3732 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
3733 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
3735 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
3736 \rightskip=0pt
3737 \ifnum\colcount=1
3738 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
3739 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
3740 \else
3741 \ifsetpercent \else
3742 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
3743 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
3744 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
3746 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
3747 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
3749 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
3750 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
3751 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
3752 % For example:
3753 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
3754 % @item @code{#}
3755 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
3756 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
3757 % marking characters.
3758 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
3759 }\cr
3761 \def\Emultitable{%
3762 \crcr
3763 \egroup % end the \halign
3764 \global\setpercentfalse
3767 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
3768 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
3770 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
3771 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
3772 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
3773 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
3774 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
3775 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
3776 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
3778 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
3779 %% table. If not, do nothing.
3780 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
3781 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
3782 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
3783 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3784 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3785 \fi%
3786 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
3787 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
3788 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
3789 %% than skip between lines in the table.
3790 \fi}
3793 \message{conditionals,}
3795 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
3796 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
3797 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
3798 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
3799 % attempt to close an environment group.
3801 \def\makecond#1{%
3802 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
3803 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
3805 \makecond{iftex}
3806 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
3807 \makecond{ifnothtml}
3808 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
3809 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
3810 \makecond{ifnotxml}
3812 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
3814 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
3815 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
3816 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
3817 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
3818 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
3819 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
3820 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
3821 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
3822 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
3823 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
3824 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
3825 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
3826 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
3828 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
3830 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
3831 \newcount\doignorecount
3833 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
3834 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
3835 \obeylines
3836 \catcode`\@ = \other
3837 \catcode`\{ = \other
3838 \catcode`\} = \other
3840 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
3841 \spaceisspace
3843 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
3844 \doignorecount = 0
3846 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
3847 \dodoignore{#1}%
3850 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
3851 \obeylines %
3853 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
3854 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
3856 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
3857 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
3858 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
3860 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
3861 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
3862 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
3863 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
3865 % And now expand that command.
3866 \doignoretext ^^M%
3870 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
3871 \def\temp{#1}%
3872 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
3873 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
3874 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
3875 \advance\doignorecount by 1
3876 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
3877 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
3879 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
3882 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
3884 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
3885 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
3886 \let\next\enddoignore
3887 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
3888 \advance\doignorecount by -1
3889 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
3891 \next
3894 % Finish off ignored text.
3895 { \obeylines%
3896 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
3897 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
3898 % would result in a blank line in the output.
3899 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
3903 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
3904 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
3906 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
3907 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
3908 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
3909 % didn't need it.
3910 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
3912 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
3913 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
3915 \makevalueexpandable
3916 \def\temp{#2}%
3917 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
3918 \ifx\temp\empty
3919 \next{}%
3920 \else
3921 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
3925 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
3926 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
3928 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
3930 \parseargdef\clear{%
3932 \makevalueexpandable
3933 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
3937 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
3938 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
3939 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
3941 \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
3943 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
3944 \let\value = \expandablevalue
3945 % We don't want these characters active, ...
3946 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
3947 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
3948 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
3949 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
3950 \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
3954 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
3955 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
3956 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
3957 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
3958 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
3959 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
3960 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
3962 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
3963 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
3964 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
3965 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
3966 \else
3967 \csname SET#1\endcsname
3971 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
3972 % with @set.
3974 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
3976 \makecond{ifset}
3977 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
3978 \def\doifset#1#2{%
3980 \makevalueexpandable
3981 \let\next=\empty
3982 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
3983 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
3985 \expandafter
3986 }\next
3988 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
3990 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
3991 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
3993 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
3994 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
3995 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
3997 \makecond{ifclear}
3998 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
3999 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
4001 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4002 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4003 \let\dircategory=\comment
4005 % @defininfoenclose.
4006 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
4009 \message{indexing,}
4010 % Index generation facilities
4012 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4013 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4014 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
4016 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
4017 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
4018 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
4019 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4020 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
4021 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4022 % for the sake of vms.
4024 \def\newindex#1{%
4025 \iflinks
4026 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
4027 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
4029 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4030 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4033 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4035 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4037 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4039 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4041 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4042 \iflinks
4043 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
4044 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
4046 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
4047 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4051 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4052 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4054 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4055 % inside @code.
4057 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4058 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4060 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4061 % #3 the target index (bar).
4062 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4063 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
4064 % closing the target index.
4065 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax
4066 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
4067 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
4068 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
4069 \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
4071 % redefine \fooindfile:
4072 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
4073 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
4074 % redefine \fooindex:
4075 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4078 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
4079 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4080 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
4082 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
4083 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
4085 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
4086 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
4088 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
4089 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4091 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4092 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
4093 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4095 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4096 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
4097 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
4099 \def\indexdummies{%
4100 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
4101 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
4102 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
4104 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
4105 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
4106 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
4107 \let\{ = \mylbrace
4108 \let\} = \myrbrace
4110 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
4111 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
4112 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
4113 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
4114 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
4115 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
4116 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
4117 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
4118 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
4120 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
4121 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
4122 % @macro funindex {WORD}
4123 % @findex xyz
4124 % @end macro
4125 % ...
4126 % @funindex commtest
4128 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
4130 % Sample whatsit resulting:
4131 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
4133 % So:
4134 \let\endinput = \empty
4136 % Do the redefinitions.
4137 \commondummies
4140 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
4141 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
4142 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
4143 % this will be simpler.
4145 \def\atdummies{%
4146 \def\@{@@}%
4147 \def\ {@ }%
4148 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
4149 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
4151 % Do the redefinitions.
4152 \commondummies
4153 \otherbackslash
4156 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
4158 \def\commondummies{%
4160 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4161 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
4162 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4163 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4164 % from whatever follows.
4166 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4167 % space.
4169 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4170 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4171 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4173 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
4174 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
4175 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4177 \commondummiesnofonts
4179 \definedummyletter\_%
4181 % Non-English letters.
4182 \definedummyword\AA
4183 \definedummyword\AE
4184 \definedummyword\L
4185 \definedummyword\OE
4186 \definedummyword\O
4187 \definedummyword\aa
4188 \definedummyword\ae
4189 \definedummyword\l
4190 \definedummyword\oe
4191 \definedummyword\o
4192 \definedummyword\ss
4193 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4194 \definedummyword\questiondown
4195 \definedummyword\ordf
4196 \definedummyword\ordm
4198 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4199 \definedummyword\bf
4200 \definedummyword\gtr
4201 \definedummyword\hat
4202 \definedummyword\less
4203 \definedummyword\sf
4204 \definedummyword\sl
4205 \definedummyword\tclose
4206 \definedummyword\tt
4208 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4209 \definedummyword\TeX
4211 % Assorted special characters.
4212 \definedummyword\bullet
4213 \definedummyword\comma
4214 \definedummyword\copyright
4215 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4216 \definedummyword\dots
4217 \definedummyword\enddots
4218 \definedummyword\equiv
4219 \definedummyword\error
4220 \definedummyword\euro
4221 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4222 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4223 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4224 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4225 \definedummyword\expansion
4226 \definedummyword\minus
4227 \definedummyword\ogonek
4228 \definedummyword\pounds
4229 \definedummyword\point
4230 \definedummyword\print
4231 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4232 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4233 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4234 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4235 \definedummyword\quoteright
4236 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4237 \definedummyword\result
4238 \definedummyword\textdegree
4240 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4241 \macrolist
4243 \normalturnoffactive
4245 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
4246 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
4247 \makevalueexpandable
4250 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
4252 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4253 % Control letters and accents.
4254 \definedummyletter\!%
4255 \definedummyaccent\"%
4256 \definedummyaccent\'%
4257 \definedummyletter\*%
4258 \definedummyaccent\,%
4259 \definedummyletter\.%
4260 \definedummyletter\/%
4261 \definedummyletter\:%
4262 \definedummyaccent\=%
4263 \definedummyletter\?%
4264 \definedummyaccent\^%
4265 \definedummyaccent\`%
4266 \definedummyaccent\~%
4267 \definedummyword\u
4268 \definedummyword\v
4269 \definedummyword\H
4270 \definedummyword\dotaccent
4271 \definedummyword\ogonek
4272 \definedummyword\ringaccent
4273 \definedummyword\tieaccent
4274 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
4275 \definedummyword\udotaccent
4276 \definedummyword\dotless
4278 % Texinfo font commands.
4279 \definedummyword\b
4280 \definedummyword\i
4281 \definedummyword\r
4282 \definedummyword\sc
4283 \definedummyword\t
4285 % Commands that take arguments.
4286 \definedummyword\acronym
4287 \definedummyword\cite
4288 \definedummyword\code
4289 \definedummyword\command
4290 \definedummyword\dfn
4291 \definedummyword\emph
4292 \definedummyword\env
4293 \definedummyword\file
4294 \definedummyword\kbd
4295 \definedummyword\key
4296 \definedummyword\math
4297 \definedummyword\option
4298 \definedummyword\pxref
4299 \definedummyword\ref
4300 \definedummyword\samp
4301 \definedummyword\strong
4302 \definedummyword\tie
4303 \definedummyword\uref
4304 \definedummyword\url
4305 \definedummyword\var
4306 \definedummyword\verb
4307 \definedummyword\w
4308 \definedummyword\xref
4311 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
4312 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
4313 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
4314 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
4316 \def\indexnofonts{%
4317 % Accent commands should become @asis.
4318 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
4319 % We can just ignore other control letters.
4320 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
4321 % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
4322 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
4324 \commondummiesnofonts
4326 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
4327 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
4328 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
4329 %\let\tt=\asis
4331 \def\ { }%
4332 \def\@{@}%
4333 % how to handle braces?
4334 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
4336 % Non-English letters.
4337 \def\AA{AA}%
4338 \def\AE{AE}%
4339 \def\L{L}%
4340 \def\OE{OE}%
4341 \def\O{O}%
4342 \def\aa{aa}%
4343 \def\ae{ae}%
4344 \def\l{l}%
4345 \def\oe{oe}%
4346 \def\o{o}%
4347 \def\ss{ss}%
4348 \def\exclamdown{!}%
4349 \def\questiondown{?}%
4350 \def\ordf{a}%
4351 \def\ordm{o}%
4353 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
4354 \def\TeX{TeX}%
4356 % Assorted special characters.
4357 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
4358 \def\bullet{bullet}%
4359 \def\comma{,}%
4360 \def\copyright{copyright}%
4361 \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
4362 \def\dots{...}%
4363 \def\enddots{...}%
4364 \def\equiv{==}%
4365 \def\error{error}%
4366 \def\euro{euro}%
4367 \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
4368 \def\guillemetright{>>}%
4369 \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
4370 \def\guilsinglright{>}%
4371 \def\expansion{==>}%
4372 \def\minus{-}%
4373 \def\pounds{pounds}%
4374 \def\point{.}%
4375 \def\print{-|}%
4376 \def\quotedblbase{"}%
4377 \def\quotedblleft{"}%
4378 \def\quotedblright{"}%
4379 \def\quoteleft{`}%
4380 \def\quoteright{'}%
4381 \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
4382 \def\result{=>}%
4383 \def\textdegree{degrees}%
4385 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
4386 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
4387 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
4388 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
4389 % that starts with \.
4391 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
4392 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
4393 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
4395 \macrolist
4398 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
4399 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
4401 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
4402 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
4403 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4405 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4406 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4407 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4408 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4410 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4411 \iflinks
4413 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4414 \toks0 = {#2}%
4415 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4416 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
4417 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4418 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4421 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
4423 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4428 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4430 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4431 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4432 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4433 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
4436 % Remember, we are within a group.
4437 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4438 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4439 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4441 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4442 % get the string to sort by.
4443 {\indexnofonts
4444 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4445 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4448 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4449 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4450 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4451 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4452 % sorted result.
4453 \edef\temp{%
4454 \write\writeto{%
4455 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4457 \temp
4460 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4462 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4463 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4464 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4465 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4466 % sequences like this:
4467 % @end defun
4468 % @tindex whatever
4469 % @defun ...
4470 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4471 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4472 % the previous defun.
4474 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4475 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4477 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4479 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4480 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4481 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4482 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4483 % representation of the skip.
4485 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4486 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4488 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
4490 \newskip\whatsitskip
4491 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4493 % ..., ready, GO:
4495 \def\safewhatsit#1{%
4496 \ifhmode
4498 \else
4499 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4500 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
4501 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4502 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
4504 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4505 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4506 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4507 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4508 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4509 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4510 \else
4511 \vskip-\whatsitskip
4516 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4517 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4518 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4519 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4520 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4521 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4523 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4524 % @vindex index-whatever
4525 % Description.
4526 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4527 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4528 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4529 \else
4530 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4531 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4532 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4533 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4538 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4539 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4540 % or
4541 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4542 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4543 % containing these kinds of lines:
4544 % \initial {c}
4545 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4546 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4547 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4548 % \primary {topic}
4549 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4550 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4551 % for each subtopic.
4553 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4554 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4556 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4557 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4558 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4559 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4560 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4561 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4563 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4564 {\obeylines %
4565 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
4566 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
4568 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4570 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4571 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4573 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4574 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4576 \smallfonts \rm
4577 \tolerance = 9500
4578 \plainfrenchspacing
4579 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4581 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4582 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4583 % \initial {@}
4584 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4585 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4586 \catcode`\@ = 11
4587 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
4588 \ifeof 1
4589 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4590 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4591 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4592 % there is some text.
4593 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4594 \else
4596 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4597 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4598 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4599 \read 1 to \temp
4600 \ifeof 1
4601 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
4602 \else
4603 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
4604 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
4605 % to make right now.
4606 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
4607 \catcode`\\ = 0
4608 \escapechar = `\\
4609 \begindoublecolumns
4610 \input \jobname.#1s
4611 \enddoublecolumns
4614 \closein 1
4615 \endgroup}
4617 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
4618 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
4620 \def\initial#1{{%
4621 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
4622 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
4624 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
4625 \removelastskip
4627 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
4628 \nobreak
4629 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
4630 \penalty 0
4631 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
4633 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
4634 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
4635 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
4636 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
4638 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
4639 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
4640 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
4641 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
4642 \nobreak
4643 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
4646 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
4647 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
4648 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
4650 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
4651 % \def\entry#1#2{...
4652 % But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
4653 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
4654 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
4656 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
4657 % --kasal, 21nov03
4658 \def\entry{%
4659 \begingroup
4661 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
4662 % affect previous text.
4663 \par
4665 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
4666 \parfillskip = 0in
4668 % No extra space above this paragraph.
4669 \parskip = 0in
4671 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
4672 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
4674 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
4675 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
4676 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
4677 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
4678 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
4680 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
4681 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
4682 \hangindent = 2em
4684 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
4685 % with blank space.
4686 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
4688 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
4689 % columns.
4690 \vskip 0pt plus1pt
4692 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
4693 \afterassignment\doentry
4694 \let\temp =
4696 \def\doentry{%
4697 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
4698 \noindent
4699 \aftergroup\finishentry
4700 % And now comes the text of the entry.
4702 \def\finishentry#1{%
4703 % #1 is the page number.
4705 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
4706 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
4707 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
4708 \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
4709 \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
4711 \else
4713 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
4714 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
4715 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
4716 \hfil\penalty50
4717 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
4719 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
4720 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
4721 % \hbox ensues.
4722 \ifpdf
4723 \pdfgettoks#1.%
4724 \ \the\toksA
4725 \else
4726 \ #1%
4729 \par
4730 \endgroup
4733 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
4734 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
4735 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
4737 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
4739 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
4740 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
4741 \parfillskip=0in
4742 \parskip=0in
4743 \hangindent=1in
4744 \hangafter=1
4745 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
4746 \ifpdf
4747 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
4748 \else
4751 \par
4754 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
4755 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
4756 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
4757 \catcode`\@=11
4759 \newbox\partialpage
4760 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
4762 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
4763 % Grab any single-column material above us.
4764 \output = {%
4766 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
4767 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
4768 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
4769 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
4770 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
4771 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
4772 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
4773 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
4774 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
4777 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
4778 % Unvbox the main output page.
4779 \unvbox\PAGE
4780 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
4783 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
4785 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
4786 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
4788 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
4789 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
4790 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
4791 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
4792 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
4794 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
4795 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
4796 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
4797 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
4798 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
4800 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
4801 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
4802 % been clobbered.
4804 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
4805 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
4806 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
4807 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
4809 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
4810 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
4811 \vsize = 2\vsize
4814 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
4815 % the last.
4817 \def\doublecolumnout{%
4818 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
4819 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
4820 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
4821 % previous page.
4822 \dimen@ = \vsize
4823 \divide\dimen@ by 2
4824 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
4826 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
4827 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
4828 \onepageout\pagesofar
4829 \unvbox255
4830 \penalty\outputpenalty
4833 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
4834 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
4835 \def\pagesofar{%
4836 \unvbox\partialpage
4838 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
4839 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
4840 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
4843 % All done with double columns.
4844 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
4845 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
4846 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
4847 % following situation:
4849 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
4850 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
4851 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
4852 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
4853 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
4854 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
4855 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
4856 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
4857 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
4858 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
4859 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
4860 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
4861 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
4862 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
4863 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
4864 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
4865 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
4866 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
4867 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
4869 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
4870 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
4871 \penalty0
4873 \output = {%
4874 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
4875 % current page, no automatic page break.
4876 \balancecolumns
4878 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
4879 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
4880 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
4881 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
4882 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
4883 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
4884 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
4885 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
4887 \eject
4888 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
4890 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
4891 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
4892 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
4893 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
4894 \pagegoal = \vsize
4897 % Called at the end of the double column material.
4898 \def\balancecolumns{%
4899 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
4900 \dimen@ = \ht0
4901 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
4902 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
4903 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
4904 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
4905 \splittopskip = \topskip
4906 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
4908 \vbadness = 10000
4909 \loop
4910 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
4911 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
4912 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
4913 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
4914 \repeat
4916 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
4917 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
4918 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
4920 \pagesofar
4922 \catcode`\@ = \other
4925 \message{sectioning,}
4926 % Chapters, sections, etc.
4928 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
4929 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
4930 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
4931 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
4932 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
4933 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
4934 \newcount\chapno
4935 \newcount\secno \secno=0
4936 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
4937 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
4939 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
4940 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
4942 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
4943 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
4944 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
4945 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
4947 \def\appendixletter{%
4948 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
4949 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
4950 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
4951 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
4952 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
4953 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
4954 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
4955 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
4956 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
4957 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
4958 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
4959 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
4960 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
4961 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
4962 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
4963 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
4964 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
4965 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
4966 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
4967 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
4968 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
4969 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
4970 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
4971 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
4972 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
4973 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
4974 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
4975 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
4976 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
4977 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
4978 \else\char\the\appendixno
4979 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
4980 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
4982 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
4983 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
4984 % these. @section does likewise.
4985 \def\thischapter{}
4986 \def\thischapternum{}
4987 \def\thischaptername{}
4988 \def\thissection{}
4989 \def\thissectionnum{}
4990 \def\thissectionname{}
4992 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
4993 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
4995 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
4996 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
4997 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
4999 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
5000 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
5001 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
5003 % we only have subsub.
5004 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
5006 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
5007 % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
5008 \chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
5010 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
5011 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
5012 \def\chapheadtype{N}
5014 % Choose a heading macro
5015 % #1 is heading type
5016 % #2 is heading level
5017 % #3 is text for heading
5018 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
5019 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
5020 \absseclevel=#2
5021 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
5022 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
5023 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
5024 \absseclevel = 0
5025 \else
5026 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
5027 \absseclevel = 3
5030 % The heading type:
5031 \def\headtype{#1}%
5032 \if \headtype U%
5033 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
5034 \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
5036 \else
5037 % Check for appendix sections:
5038 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
5039 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
5040 \else
5041 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
5042 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
5043 \fi\fi
5045 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
5046 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
5047 \def\headtype{U}%
5048 \else
5049 \chardef\unmlevel = 3
5052 % Now print the heading:
5053 \if \headtype U%
5054 \ifcase\absseclevel
5055 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
5056 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
5057 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5058 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5060 \else
5061 \if \headtype A%
5062 \ifcase\absseclevel
5063 \appendixzzz{#3}%
5064 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
5065 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
5066 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5068 \else
5069 \ifcase\absseclevel
5070 \chapterzzz{#3}%
5071 \or \seczzz{#3}%
5072 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5073 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5077 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5080 % an interface:
5081 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
5082 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
5083 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
5085 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
5086 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
5088 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
5089 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
5090 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
5092 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
5093 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
5094 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
5095 % as an @include file.
5096 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5097 \global\advance\chapno by 1
5099 % Used for \float.
5100 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
5101 \resetallfloatnos
5103 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
5105 % Write the actual heading.
5106 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
5108 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
5109 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
5110 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
5111 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
5114 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
5115 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
5116 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5117 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
5118 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
5119 \resetallfloatnos
5121 \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
5122 \message{\appendixnum}%
5124 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
5126 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
5127 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
5128 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
5131 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
5132 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
5133 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5134 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
5136 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
5137 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
5138 \resetallfloatnos
5140 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
5141 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
5142 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
5143 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
5144 % to be executed, not expanded).
5146 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
5147 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
5148 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
5149 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
5150 % the toc entries.)
5151 \toks0 = {#1}%
5152 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
5154 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
5156 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
5157 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
5158 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
5161 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
5162 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
5163 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
5164 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
5165 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
5166 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
5167 \unnmhead0{#1}%
5168 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
5171 % @top is like @unnumbered.
5172 \let\top\unnumbered
5174 % Sections.
5175 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
5176 \def\seczzz#1{%
5177 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5178 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
5181 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
5182 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
5183 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5184 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
5186 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
5188 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
5189 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
5190 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5191 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
5194 % Subsections.
5195 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
5196 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
5197 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5198 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5201 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
5202 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
5203 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5204 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
5205 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5208 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
5209 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
5210 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5211 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
5212 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5215 % Subsubsections.
5216 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
5217 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5218 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5219 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
5220 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5223 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
5224 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
5225 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5226 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
5227 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5230 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
5231 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5232 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5233 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
5234 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5237 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
5238 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
5239 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
5240 \let\section = \numberedsec
5241 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
5242 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
5244 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
5246 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
5247 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
5248 % overlong headings to fold.
5249 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
5250 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
5251 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
5252 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
5254 \def\majorheading{%
5255 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
5256 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
5259 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
5260 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
5261 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
5262 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
5263 \rmisbold #1\hfill}}%
5264 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
5265 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5268 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
5269 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5270 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5271 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5272 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5273 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5274 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5276 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
5277 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
5278 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
5280 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
5281 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
5283 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
5284 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
5286 \newskip\chapheadingskip
5288 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
5289 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
5290 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
5291 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
5292 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
5293 \def\chapoddpage{%
5294 \chappager
5295 \ifodd\pageno \else
5296 \begingroup
5297 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
5298 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
5299 \hbox to 0pt{}%
5300 \chappager
5301 \endgroup
5305 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
5307 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
5308 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5309 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
5310 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
5312 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
5313 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5314 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
5315 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
5316 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
5318 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
5319 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
5320 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
5321 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
5322 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
5324 \CHAPPAGon
5326 % Chapter opening.
5328 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
5329 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
5331 % To test against our argument.
5332 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
5333 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
5334 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
5336 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
5337 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5338 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5339 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5340 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5341 \gdef\thissection{}}%
5343 \def\temptype{#2}%
5344 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5345 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5346 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
5347 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5348 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5349 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
5350 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5351 \toks0={#1}%
5352 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5353 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5354 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
5355 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
5356 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5358 \else
5359 \toks0={#1}%
5360 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5361 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5362 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
5363 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \noexpand\thischapternum:
5364 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5366 \fi\fi\fi
5368 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5369 % the preceding space.
5370 \safewhatsit\domark
5372 % Insert the chapter heading break.
5373 \pchapsepmacro
5375 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5376 % between here and the heading.
5377 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5378 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5379 \domark
5382 \chapfonts \rmisbold
5384 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
5385 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
5386 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
5387 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5389 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
5390 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
5391 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5392 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5393 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
5394 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5395 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
5396 \def\toctype{omit}%
5397 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5398 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
5399 \def\toctype{app}%
5400 \else
5401 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
5402 \def\toctype{numchap}%
5403 \fi\fi\fi
5405 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
5406 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
5407 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
5408 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
5410 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
5411 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
5412 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
5413 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
5414 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
5415 \donoderef{#2}%
5417 % Typeset the actual heading.
5418 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
5419 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
5420 \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
5421 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
5423 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
5424 \nobreak
5427 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
5428 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
5429 \def\centerparameters{%
5430 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
5431 \leftskip = \rightskip
5432 \parfillskip = 0pt
5436 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
5437 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
5439 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
5441 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
5442 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
5443 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
5444 \rmisbold #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5446 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
5447 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5448 \par\penalty 5000 %
5450 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5451 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
5452 \parindent=0pt
5453 \hfill {\rmisbold #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
5455 \def\CHAPFopen{%
5456 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
5457 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
5460 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5461 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5463 \newskip\secheadingskip
5464 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
5466 % Subsection titles.
5467 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5468 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
5470 % Subsubsection titles.
5471 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5472 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5475 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5477 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
5478 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
5479 % section number.
5481 \def\seckeyword{sec}
5483 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5485 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5486 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold
5488 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5489 \def\temptype{#3}%
5491 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5492 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5493 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5494 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5495 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5496 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
5498 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5499 % Don't redefine \thissection.
5500 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5501 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5502 \toks0={#1}%
5503 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5504 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5505 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5506 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5507 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5510 \else
5511 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5512 \toks0={#1}%
5513 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5514 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5515 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5516 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\putwordSection{} \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5517 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5520 \fi\fi\fi
5522 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
5523 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
5524 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
5525 \par
5527 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5528 % the preceding space.
5529 \safewhatsit\domark
5531 % Insert space above the heading.
5532 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
5534 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5535 % between here and the heading.
5536 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5537 \domark
5539 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5540 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5541 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5542 \def\toctype{unn}%
5543 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5544 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5545 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5546 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
5547 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5548 \def\toctype{omit}%
5549 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
5550 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5551 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5552 \def\toctype{app}%
5553 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5554 \else
5555 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5556 \def\toctype{num}%
5557 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5558 \fi\fi\fi
5560 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
5561 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
5563 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
5564 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
5565 \donoderef{#3}%
5567 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
5568 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
5569 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
5570 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
5571 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
5572 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
5573 \nobreak
5575 % Output the actual section heading.
5576 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
5577 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
5578 \unhbox0 #1}%
5580 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
5581 % Don't allow stretch, though.
5582 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
5584 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
5585 % was followed by glue.
5586 \nobreak
5588 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
5589 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
5590 % discardable item.)
5591 \vskip-\parskip
5593 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
5594 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
5595 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
5597 % @section sec-whatever
5598 % @deffn def-whatever
5599 \penalty 10001
5603 \message{toc,}
5604 % Table of contents.
5605 \newwrite\tocfile
5607 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
5608 % Called from @chapter, etc.
5610 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
5611 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
5612 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
5613 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
5614 % destination to jump to.
5616 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
5617 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
5618 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
5619 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
5621 \newif\iftocfileopened
5622 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
5624 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
5625 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
5626 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
5627 \iftocfileopened\else
5628 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
5629 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
5632 \iflinks
5633 {\atdummies
5634 \edef\temp{%
5635 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
5636 \temp
5641 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
5642 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
5643 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
5644 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
5645 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
5646 % `1', and two named `2'.
5647 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
5651 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
5652 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
5653 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
5655 \def\activecatcodes{%
5656 \catcode`\"=\active
5657 \catcode`\$=\active
5658 \catcode`\<=\active
5659 \catcode`\>=\active
5660 \catcode`\\=\active
5661 \catcode`\^=\active
5662 \catcode`\_=\active
5663 \catcode`\|=\active
5664 \catcode`\~=\active
5668 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
5669 \def\readtocfile{%
5670 \setupdatafile
5671 \activecatcodes
5672 \input \tocreadfilename
5675 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
5676 \newcount\savepageno
5677 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
5679 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
5681 \def\startcontents#1{%
5682 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
5683 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
5684 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
5685 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
5686 \contentsalignmacro
5687 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
5689 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
5690 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
5691 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
5693 \savepageno = \pageno
5694 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
5695 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
5696 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
5698 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
5699 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
5702 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
5703 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
5705 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
5707 % Normal (long) toc.
5709 \def\contents{%
5710 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
5711 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5712 \ifeof 1 \else
5713 \readtocfile
5715 \vfill \eject
5716 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5717 \ifeof 1 \else
5718 \pdfmakeoutlines
5720 \closein 1
5721 \endgroup
5722 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
5723 \global\pageno = \savepageno
5726 % And just the chapters.
5727 \def\summarycontents{%
5728 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
5730 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
5731 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
5732 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
5733 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
5734 \secfonts
5735 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
5736 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
5738 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
5739 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
5740 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
5741 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
5742 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
5743 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5744 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5745 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5746 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5747 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5748 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
5749 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
5750 \ifeof 1 \else
5751 \readtocfile
5753 \closein 1
5754 \vfill \eject
5755 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
5756 \endgroup
5757 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
5758 \global\pageno = \savepageno
5760 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
5762 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
5763 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
5765 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
5766 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
5767 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
5768 % But use \hss just in case.
5769 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
5770 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
5772 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
5773 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
5774 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
5775 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
5776 % there are before deciding ...
5777 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
5780 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
5781 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
5782 % The last argument is the page number.
5783 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
5785 % Chapters, in the main contents.
5786 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5788 % Chapters, in the short toc.
5789 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
5790 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
5791 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
5794 % Appendices, in the main contents.
5795 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
5797 \def\appendixbox#1{%
5798 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
5799 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
5800 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
5802 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5804 % Unnumbered chapters.
5805 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
5806 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
5808 % Sections.
5809 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5810 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
5811 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
5813 % Subsections.
5814 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5815 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
5816 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5818 % And subsubsections.
5819 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
5820 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
5821 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
5823 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
5824 % Same as \defaultparindent.
5825 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
5827 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
5828 % page number.
5830 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
5831 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
5832 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
5833 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
5834 \begingroup
5835 \chapentryfonts
5836 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5837 \endgroup
5838 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
5841 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5842 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
5843 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5844 \endgroup}
5846 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5847 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
5848 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5849 \endgroup}
5851 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
5852 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
5853 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
5854 \endgroup}
5856 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
5857 \let\tocentry = \entry
5859 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
5860 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
5862 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5863 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
5865 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
5866 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
5867 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5868 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
5871 \message{environments,}
5872 % @foo ... @end foo.
5874 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
5875 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
5876 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
5878 \envdef\tex{%
5879 \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
5880 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
5881 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
5882 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
5883 \catcode `\%=14
5884 \catcode `\+=\other
5885 \catcode `\"=\other
5886 \catcode `\|=\other
5887 \catcode `\<=\other
5888 \catcode `\>=\other
5889 \catcode`\`=\other
5890 \catcode`\'=\other
5891 \escapechar=`\\
5893 \let\b=\ptexb
5894 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
5895 \let\c=\ptexc
5896 \let\,=\ptexcomma
5897 \let\.=\ptexdot
5898 \let\dots=\ptexdots
5899 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
5900 \let\!=\ptexexclam
5901 \let\i=\ptexi
5902 \let\indent=\ptexindent
5903 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
5904 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
5905 \let\+=\tabalign
5906 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
5907 \let\/=\ptexslash
5908 \let\*=\ptexstar
5909 \let\t=\ptext
5910 \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % outer
5911 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
5913 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
5914 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
5915 \def\@{@}%
5917 % There is no need to define \Etex.
5919 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
5920 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
5921 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
5923 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
5924 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
5926 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
5927 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
5928 % have any width.
5929 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
5931 % This space is always present above and below environments.
5932 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
5934 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
5935 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
5936 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
5937 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
5939 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
5940 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
5941 % \sectionheading, q.v.
5942 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
5943 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
5944 \endgraf
5945 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
5946 \removelastskip
5947 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
5948 % or better ...
5949 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
5950 \vskip\envskipamount
5955 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
5957 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
5958 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
5959 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
5961 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
5962 % environment contents.
5963 \font\circle=lcircle10
5964 \newdimen\circthick
5965 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
5966 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
5967 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
5969 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
5970 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
5971 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
5972 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
5973 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5974 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
5975 \hskip\rskip}}
5976 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
5977 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
5978 \hskip\rskip}}
5980 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
5982 \envdef\cartouche{%
5983 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
5984 \startsavinginserts
5985 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
5986 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
5987 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
5988 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
5989 \cartouter=\hsize
5990 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
5991 % side, and for 6pt waste from
5992 % each corner char, and rule thickness
5993 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
5994 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
5995 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5996 \vbox\bgroup
5997 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
5998 \carttop
5999 \hbox\bgroup
6000 \hskip\lskip
6001 \vrule\kern3pt
6002 \vbox\bgroup
6003 \kern3pt
6004 \hsize=\cartinner
6005 \baselineskip=\normbskip
6006 \lineskip=\normlskip
6007 \parskip=\normpskip
6008 \vskip -\parskip
6009 \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
6011 \def\Ecartouche{%
6012 \ifhmode\par\fi
6013 \kern3pt
6014 \egroup
6015 \kern3pt\vrule
6016 \hskip\rskip
6017 \egroup
6018 \cartbot
6019 \egroup
6020 \checkinserts
6024 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
6025 % inside a group.
6026 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
6027 \def\nonfillstart{%
6028 \aboveenvbreak
6029 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
6030 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
6031 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
6032 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
6033 \parskip = 0pt
6034 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
6035 % the normal \indent.
6036 \nonfillparindent=\parindent
6037 \parindent = 0pt
6038 \let\indent\nonfillindent
6040 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
6041 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6042 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
6043 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
6044 \else
6045 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
6047 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
6050 \begingroup
6051 \obeyspaces
6052 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
6053 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
6054 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
6055 % @indent.
6056 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
6057 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
6058 \ifx\temp %
6059 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
6060 \else%
6061 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
6062 \fi%
6064 \endgroup
6065 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
6066 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
6068 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
6069 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
6070 % This affects the following displayed environments:
6071 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
6073 \def\smallword{small}
6074 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
6075 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
6076 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
6077 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
6078 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
6079 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
6080 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
6081 % to change the fonts afterward.
6082 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6083 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6086 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
6087 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
6088 \else
6089 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6090 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6094 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
6095 % Let's do it by one command:
6096 \def\makedispenv #1#2{
6097 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
6098 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
6099 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6100 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6103 % Define two synonyms:
6104 \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
6105 \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
6106 \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
6109 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
6111 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
6112 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
6114 \maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
6115 \nonfillstart
6116 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
6117 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
6118 \gobble % eat return
6120 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
6122 \makedispenv {display}{%
6123 \nonfillstart
6124 \gobble
6127 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
6129 \makedispenv{format}{%
6130 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6131 \nonfillstart
6132 \gobble
6135 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
6136 \envdef\flushleft{%
6137 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6138 \nonfillstart
6139 \gobble
6141 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
6143 % @flushright.
6145 \envdef\flushright{%
6146 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6147 \nonfillstart
6148 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
6149 \gobble
6151 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
6154 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
6155 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
6156 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
6157 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
6159 \def\quotationstart{%
6160 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
6161 \parindent=0pt
6163 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
6164 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6165 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
6166 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
6167 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
6168 \else
6169 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
6171 \parsearg\quotationlabel
6174 \envdef\quotation{%
6175 \setnormaldispenv
6176 \quotationstart
6179 \envdef\smallquotation{%
6180 \setsmalldispenv
6181 \quotationstart
6183 \let\Esmallquotation = \Equotation
6185 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
6186 % doing normal filling.
6188 \def\Equotation{%
6189 \par
6190 \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
6191 % indent a bit.
6192 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
6194 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
6197 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
6198 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
6199 \def\temp{#1}%
6200 \ifx\temp\empty \else
6201 {\bf #1: }%
6206 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
6207 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
6208 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
6209 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
6211 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
6213 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
6214 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
6215 % verbatim line.
6216 \def\dospecials{%
6217 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
6218 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
6219 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
6220 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
6221 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
6222 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
6223 %\do\`\do\'%
6226 % [Knuth] p. 380
6227 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
6228 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
6230 % Setup for the @verb command.
6232 % Eight spaces for a tab
6233 \begingroup
6234 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6235 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
6236 \endgroup
6238 \def\setupverb{%
6239 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6240 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
6241 \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
6242 \tabeightspaces
6243 % Respect line breaks,
6244 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6245 % make each space count
6246 % must do in this order:
6247 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6250 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
6252 % Real tab expansion
6253 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
6255 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
6257 \begingroup
6258 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6259 \gdef\tabexpand{%
6260 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6261 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
6262 \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
6263 \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
6264 \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
6265 \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
6266 \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
6269 \endgroup
6271 % start the verbatim environment.
6272 \def\setupverbatim{%
6273 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6274 \nonfillstart
6275 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6277 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
6278 \tabexpand
6279 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
6280 % Respect line breaks,
6281 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6282 % make each space count
6283 % must do in this order:
6284 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6285 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
6288 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
6289 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
6290 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
6292 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
6294 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
6295 \begingroup
6296 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
6297 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
6298 \endgroup
6300 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
6303 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
6304 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
6306 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
6308 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
6309 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
6310 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
6312 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
6314 \begingroup
6315 \catcode`\ =\active
6316 \obeylines %
6317 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
6318 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
6319 % line in the output.
6320 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
6321 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
6322 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
6323 \endgroup
6325 \envdef\verbatim{%
6326 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
6328 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
6331 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
6333 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
6335 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
6337 \makevalueexpandable
6338 \setupverbatim
6339 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
6340 \input #1
6341 \afterenvbreak
6345 % @copying ... @end copying.
6346 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
6348 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
6349 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
6350 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
6351 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
6352 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
6353 % possible is very desirable.
6355 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
6356 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
6358 \def\insertcopying{%
6359 \begingroup
6360 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
6361 \scanexp\copyingtext
6362 \endgroup
6366 \message{defuns,}
6367 % @defun etc.
6369 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
6370 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
6371 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
6372 \newcount\defunpenalty
6374 % Start the processing of @deffn:
6375 \def\startdefun{%
6376 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
6377 \medbreak
6378 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
6379 % following @def command, see below.
6380 \else
6381 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
6382 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
6383 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
6384 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
6385 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
6386 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
6387 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
6389 % As a minor refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
6390 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
6391 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
6392 % @def command.
6393 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6395 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
6396 % But do insert the glue.
6397 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
6400 \parindent=0in
6401 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
6402 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
6405 \def\dodefunx#1{%
6406 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
6407 \checkenv#1%
6409 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
6410 % It's not a great place, though.
6411 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6413 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
6414 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
6416 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
6418 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
6420 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
6421 \begingroup
6422 % call \deffnheader:
6423 #1#2 \endheader
6424 % common ending:
6425 \interlinepenalty = 10000
6426 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
6427 \endgraf
6428 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
6429 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
6430 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
6431 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
6432 \checkparencounts
6433 \endgroup
6436 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
6438 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
6439 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
6441 \def\makedefun#1{%
6442 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
6443 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
6444 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
6445 \temp
6448 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
6450 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
6451 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
6453 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
6454 \envdef#1{%
6455 \startdefun
6456 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
6458 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
6459 \def#3%
6462 %%% Untyped functions:
6464 % @deffn category name args
6465 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
6467 % @deffn category class name args
6468 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6470 % \defopon {category on}class name args
6471 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6473 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
6475 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
6476 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
6477 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
6478 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
6481 %%% Typed functions:
6483 % @deftypefn category type name args
6484 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
6486 % @deftypeop category class type name args
6487 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6489 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
6490 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6492 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
6494 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6495 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6496 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6499 %%% Typed variables:
6501 % @deftypevr category type var args
6502 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
6504 % @deftypecv category class type var args
6505 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
6507 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
6508 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6510 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
6512 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
6513 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
6514 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
6517 %%% Untyped variables:
6519 % @defvr category var args
6520 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
6522 % @defcv category class var args
6523 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
6525 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
6526 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
6528 %%% Type:
6529 % @deftp category name args
6530 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
6531 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
6532 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
6535 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
6536 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6537 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
6538 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
6539 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
6540 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6541 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
6542 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
6543 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
6544 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
6545 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6546 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
6548 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
6549 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
6550 % #2 is the return type, if any.
6551 % #3 is the function name.
6553 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
6555 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
6556 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
6557 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
6559 % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
6560 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
6561 % just below it.
6562 \def\temp{#1}%
6563 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
6565 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
6566 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
6567 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
6568 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
6569 % The continuations:
6570 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
6571 % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
6572 \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
6574 % Put the type name to the right margin.
6575 \noindent
6576 \hbox to 0pt{%
6577 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
6578 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
6579 \kern\leftskip
6580 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
6583 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
6584 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
6585 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
6587 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
6588 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
6589 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
6590 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
6591 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
6592 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
6593 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
6594 % one has made identifiers using them :).
6595 \df \tt
6596 \def\temp{#2}% return value type
6597 \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
6598 #3% output function name
6600 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
6602 \boldbrax
6603 % arguments will be output next, if any.
6606 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
6607 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
6608 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
6609 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
6611 \def\defunargs#1{%
6612 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
6613 % tt for the names.
6614 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
6616 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
6617 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
6618 \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
6620 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
6623 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
6625 \def\activeparens{%
6626 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
6627 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
6628 \catcode`\&=\active
6631 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
6632 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
6634 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
6635 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
6636 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
6638 \activeparens
6639 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
6640 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
6641 \global\let& = \&
6643 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
6644 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
6647 \newcount\parencount
6649 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
6650 \newif\ifampseen
6651 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
6653 \def\parenfont{%
6654 \ifampseen
6655 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
6656 % otherwise use the default font.
6657 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
6658 \else
6659 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
6660 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
6664 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
6665 \ifampseen
6666 \ifnum\parencount=1
6671 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
6673 \def\opnr{%
6674 \global\advance\parencount by 1
6675 {\parenfont(}%
6676 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
6678 \def\clnr{%
6679 {\parenfont)}%
6680 \infirstlevel \sl
6681 \global\advance\parencount by -1
6684 \newcount\brackcount
6685 \def\lbrb{%
6686 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
6687 {\bf[}%
6689 \def\rbrb{%
6690 {\bf]}%
6691 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
6694 \def\checkparencounts{%
6695 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
6696 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
6698 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
6699 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
6700 \def\badparencount{%
6701 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
6702 \global\parencount=0
6704 \def\badbrackcount{%
6705 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
6706 \global\brackcount=0
6710 \message{macros,}
6711 % @macro.
6713 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
6714 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
6715 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
6716 \newwrite\macscribble
6717 \def\scantokens#1{%
6718 \toks0={#1}%
6719 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
6720 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
6721 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
6722 \input \jobname.tmp
6726 \def\scanmacro#1{%
6727 \begingroup
6728 \newlinechar`\^^M
6729 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
6730 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
6731 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
6732 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
6733 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
6734 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
6735 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
6736 % ... and \example
6737 \spaceisspace
6739 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
6740 % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
6741 % --kasal, 29nov03
6742 \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
6743 \endgroup
6746 \def\scanexp#1{%
6747 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
6748 \temp
6751 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
6752 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
6753 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
6755 % List of all defined macros in the form
6756 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
6757 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
6758 % if there is a need.
6759 \def\macrolist{}
6761 % Add the macro to \macrolist
6762 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
6763 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
6764 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
6765 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
6768 % Utility routines.
6769 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
6770 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
6771 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
6773 \def\cslet#1#2{%
6774 \expandafter\let
6775 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
6776 \csname#2\endcsname
6779 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
6780 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
6781 {\catcode`\@=11
6782 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
6783 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
6784 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
6785 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
6786 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
6789 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
6790 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
6791 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
6792 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
6793 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
6796 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
6797 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
6798 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
6800 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
6801 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
6802 % confine the change to the current group.
6804 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
6805 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
6806 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
6808 \def\scanctxt{%
6809 \catcode`\"=\other
6810 \catcode`\+=\other
6811 \catcode`\<=\other
6812 \catcode`\>=\other
6813 \catcode`\@=\other
6814 \catcode`\^=\other
6815 \catcode`\_=\other
6816 \catcode`\|=\other
6817 \catcode`\~=\other
6818 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
6821 \def\scanargctxt{%
6822 \scanctxt
6823 \catcode`\\=\other
6824 \catcode`\^^M=\other
6827 \def\macrobodyctxt{%
6828 \scanctxt
6829 \catcode`\{=\other
6830 \catcode`\}=\other
6831 \catcode`\^^M=\other
6832 \usembodybackslash
6835 \def\macroargctxt{%
6836 \scanctxt
6837 \catcode`\\=\other
6840 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
6841 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
6842 % where N is the macro parameter number.
6843 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
6844 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
6846 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
6847 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
6848 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
6850 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
6852 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
6853 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
6855 \def\macroxxx#1{%
6856 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
6857 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
6858 \paramno=0%
6859 \else
6860 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
6862 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
6863 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
6864 \else
6865 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
6866 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
6867 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
6868 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
6869 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
6871 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
6872 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
6873 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
6874 \fi}
6876 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
6877 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
6878 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
6879 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
6880 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
6881 \begingroup
6882 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
6883 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
6884 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
6885 \endgroup
6886 \else
6887 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
6891 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
6892 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
6894 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
6895 \ifx #1\relax
6896 % remove this
6897 \else
6898 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
6902 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
6903 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
6904 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
6905 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
6906 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
6907 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
6908 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
6910 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
6911 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
6912 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
6913 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
6915 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
6916 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
6917 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
6918 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
6920 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
6921 % the macro is used.
6923 \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
6924 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
6925 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
6926 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
6927 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
6928 \advance\paramno by 1%
6929 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
6930 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
6931 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
6932 \fi\next}
6934 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
6935 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
6937 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
6938 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6939 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
6940 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
6942 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
6943 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
6944 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
6945 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
6946 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
6947 \def\defmacro{%
6948 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
6949 \ifrecursive
6950 \ifcase\paramno
6952 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6953 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6954 \or % 1
6955 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6956 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6957 \noexpand\braceorline
6958 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
6959 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
6960 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6961 \else % many
6962 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6963 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6964 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
6965 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
6966 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
6967 \expandafter\expandafter
6968 \expandafter\xdef
6969 \expandafter\expandafter
6970 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
6971 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
6973 \else
6974 \ifcase\paramno
6976 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6977 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6978 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6979 \or % 1
6980 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6981 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6982 \noexpand\braceorline
6983 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
6984 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
6985 \egroup
6986 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
6987 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
6988 \else % many
6989 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
6990 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
6991 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
6992 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
6993 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
6994 \expandafter\expandafter
6995 \expandafter\xdef
6996 \expandafter\expandafter
6997 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
6998 \paramlist{%
6999 \egroup
7000 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7001 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7003 \fi}
7005 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
7007 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
7008 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
7009 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
7010 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
7011 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
7012 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
7013 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
7014 \expandafter\parsearg
7015 \fi \macnamexxx}
7018 % @alias.
7019 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
7020 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
7021 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
7022 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
7023 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
7025 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
7026 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
7027 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
7029 \next
7033 \message{cross references,}
7035 \newwrite\auxfile
7036 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
7037 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
7039 % @inforef is relatively simple.
7040 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
7041 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
7042 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
7044 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
7045 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
7046 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
7047 % @node foo , bar , ...
7048 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
7050 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
7052 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
7053 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
7054 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
7055 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
7057 \let\nwnode=\node
7058 \let\lastnode=\empty
7060 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
7061 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
7063 \def\donoderef#1{%
7064 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
7065 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
7066 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
7070 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
7072 \newcount\savesfregister
7074 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
7075 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
7076 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
7078 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
7079 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
7080 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
7081 % or the anchor name.
7082 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
7083 % empty for anchors.
7084 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
7086 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
7087 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
7088 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
7090 \def\setref#1#2{%
7091 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
7092 \iflinks
7094 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
7095 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
7096 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
7097 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
7099 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
7100 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
7101 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
7102 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, during \shipout
7107 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
7108 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
7109 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
7110 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
7112 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7113 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7114 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7115 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
7116 \unsepspaces
7117 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
7118 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
7119 \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
7120 \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
7121 \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
7122 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
7123 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
7124 % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
7125 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7126 \else
7127 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
7128 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
7129 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
7130 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
7131 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7132 \else
7133 \ifhavexrefs
7134 % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
7135 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
7136 \else
7137 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
7138 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7139 \fi%
7144 % Make link in pdf output.
7145 \ifpdf
7146 {\indexnofonts
7147 \turnoffactive
7148 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
7149 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions.
7150 \getfilename{#4}%
7152 % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
7153 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
7154 \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
7156 \leavevmode
7157 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
7158 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
7159 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
7160 \else
7161 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
7164 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
7167 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
7168 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
7169 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
7171 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
7172 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
7173 \indexnofonts
7174 \turnoffactive
7175 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
7176 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
7178 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
7179 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
7180 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
7181 \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
7182 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
7183 \else
7184 \printedrefname
7187 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
7188 % "in MANUALNAME".
7189 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
7190 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
7192 \else
7193 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
7195 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
7196 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
7197 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
7198 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
7199 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
7200 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
7201 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
7202 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
7203 \else
7204 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
7205 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
7206 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
7207 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
7208 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
7209 {\turnoffactive
7210 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
7211 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
7212 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
7213 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
7215 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
7216 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
7218 % But we always want a comma and a space:
7219 ,\space
7221 % output the `page 3'.
7222 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
7225 \endlink
7226 \endgroup}
7228 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
7229 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
7230 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
7231 % one that Bob is working on :).
7233 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
7235 % Things referred to by \setref.
7237 \def\Ynothing{}
7238 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
7239 \def\Ynumbered{%
7240 \ifnum\secno=0
7241 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
7242 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
7243 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
7244 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
7245 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
7246 \else
7247 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
7248 \fi\fi\fi
7250 \def\Yappendix{%
7251 \ifnum\secno=0
7252 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
7253 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
7254 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
7255 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
7256 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
7257 \else
7258 \putwordSection@tie
7259 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
7260 \fi\fi\fi
7263 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
7264 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
7266 \def\refx#1#2{%
7268 \indexnofonts
7269 \otherbackslash
7270 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
7271 \csname XR#1\endcsname
7273 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
7274 % If not defined, say something at least.
7275 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
7276 \iflinks
7277 \ifhavexrefs
7278 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
7279 \else
7280 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
7281 \global\warnedxrefstrue
7282 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
7286 \else
7287 % It's defined, so just use it.
7288 \thisrefX
7290 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
7293 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
7294 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
7295 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
7297 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
7298 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
7299 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
7300 % mess up the control sequence name.
7301 \indexnofonts
7302 \turnoffactive
7303 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
7306 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
7308 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
7309 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
7310 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
7311 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
7312 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
7314 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
7315 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
7316 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
7317 \else
7318 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
7319 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
7322 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
7323 % for later use in \listoffloats.
7324 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
7325 {\safexrefname}}%
7329 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
7331 \def\tryauxfile{%
7332 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
7333 \ifeof 1 \else
7334 \readdatafile{aux}%
7335 \global\havexrefstrue
7337 \closein 1
7340 \def\setupdatafile{%
7341 \catcode`\^^@=\other
7342 \catcode`\^^A=\other
7343 \catcode`\^^B=\other
7344 \catcode`\^^C=\other
7345 \catcode`\^^D=\other
7346 \catcode`\^^E=\other
7347 \catcode`\^^F=\other
7348 \catcode`\^^G=\other
7349 \catcode`\^^H=\other
7350 \catcode`\^^K=\other
7351 \catcode`\^^L=\other
7352 \catcode`\^^N=\other
7353 \catcode`\^^P=\other
7354 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
7355 \catcode`\^^R=\other
7356 \catcode`\^^S=\other
7357 \catcode`\^^T=\other
7358 \catcode`\^^U=\other
7359 \catcode`\^^V=\other
7360 \catcode`\^^W=\other
7361 \catcode`\^^X=\other
7362 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
7363 \catcode`\^^[=\other
7364 \catcode`\^^\=\other
7365 \catcode`\^^]=\other
7366 \catcode`\^^^=\other
7367 \catcode`\^^_=\other
7368 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
7369 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
7370 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
7371 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
7372 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
7373 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
7374 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
7375 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
7377 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
7378 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
7379 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
7381 \catcode`\^=\other
7383 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
7384 \catcode`\~=\other
7385 \catcode`\[=\other
7386 \catcode`\]=\other
7387 \catcode`\"=\other
7388 \catcode`\_=\other
7389 \catcode`\|=\other
7390 \catcode`\<=\other
7391 \catcode`\>=\other
7392 \catcode`\$=\other
7393 \catcode`\#=\other
7394 \catcode`\&=\other
7395 \catcode`\%=\other
7396 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
7398 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
7399 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
7400 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
7401 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
7402 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
7403 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
7404 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
7405 \catcode`\\=\other
7407 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
7409 \count1=128
7410 \def\loop{%
7411 \catcode\count1=\other
7412 \advance\count1 by 1
7413 \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
7417 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
7418 \catcode`\{=1
7419 \catcode`\}=2
7420 \catcode`\@=0
7423 \def\readdatafile#1{%
7424 \begingroup
7425 \setupdatafile
7426 \input\jobname.#1
7427 \endgroup}
7430 \message{insertions,}
7431 % including footnotes.
7433 \newcount \footnoteno
7435 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
7436 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
7437 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
7438 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
7439 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
7440 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
7442 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
7443 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
7445 {\catcode `\@=11
7447 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
7448 \gdef\footnote{%
7449 \let\indent=\ptexindent
7450 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
7451 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
7452 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
7454 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
7455 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
7456 \let\@sf\empty
7457 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
7459 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
7460 \unskip
7461 \thisfootno\@sf
7462 \dofootnote
7465 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
7466 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
7468 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
7469 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
7470 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
7472 \gdef\dofootnote{%
7473 \insert\footins\bgroup
7474 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
7475 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
7476 % So reset some parameters.
7477 \hsize=\pagewidth
7478 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
7479 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
7480 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
7481 \floatingpenalty\@MM
7482 \leftskip\z@skip
7483 \rightskip\z@skip
7484 \spaceskip\z@skip
7485 \xspaceskip\z@skip
7486 \parindent\defaultparindent
7488 \smallfonts \rm
7490 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
7491 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
7492 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
7493 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
7494 \let\noindent = \relax
7496 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
7497 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
7498 \everypar = {\hang}%
7499 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
7501 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
7502 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
7503 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
7504 \footstrut
7505 \futurelet\next\fo@t
7507 }%end \catcode `\@=11
7509 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
7510 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
7511 % would be lost.
7512 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
7513 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
7514 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
7516 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
7517 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
7518 % out prematurely.
7520 \def\startsavinginserts{%
7521 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
7522 \let\insert\saveinsert
7523 \else
7524 \let\checkinserts\relax
7528 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
7529 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
7531 \def\saveinsert#1{%
7532 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
7533 \afterassignment\next
7534 % swallow the left brace
7535 \let\temp =
7537 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
7538 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
7540 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
7542 \def\placesaveins#1{%
7543 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
7544 {\box#1}%
7547 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
7549 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
7550 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
7553 % initialization:
7554 \def\newsaveins #1{%
7555 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
7556 \next
7558 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
7559 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
7560 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
7561 \checksaveins #1}%
7564 % initialize:
7565 \let\checkinserts\empty
7566 \newsaveins\footins
7567 \newsaveins\margin
7570 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
7571 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
7573 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
7574 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
7575 % undone and the next image would fail.
7576 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
7577 \ifeof 1 \else
7578 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
7579 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
7580 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
7581 \input epsf.tex
7583 \closein 1
7585 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
7586 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
7587 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
7588 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
7589 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
7591 \def\image#1{%
7592 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
7593 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
7594 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
7595 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
7596 \global\warnednoepsftrue
7598 \else
7599 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
7603 % Arguments to @image:
7604 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
7605 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
7606 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
7607 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
7608 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
7609 \newif\ifimagevmode
7610 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
7611 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
7612 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
7613 % If the image is by itself, center it.
7614 \ifvmode
7615 \imagevmodetrue
7616 \nobreak\medskip
7617 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
7618 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
7619 % above and below.
7620 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
7621 \nobreak
7624 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
7625 % environment such as @quotation is respected. On the other hand, if
7626 % it's at the top level, we don't want the normal paragraph indentation.
7627 \noindent
7629 % Output the image.
7630 \ifpdf
7631 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
7632 \else
7633 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
7634 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
7635 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
7636 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
7639 \ifimagevmode \medskip \fi % space after the standalone image
7640 \endgroup}
7643 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
7644 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
7645 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
7647 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
7649 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
7650 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
7652 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
7653 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
7654 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
7656 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
7657 % be referable.
7659 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
7660 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
7662 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
7663 % chapter-level command.
7664 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
7666 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
7667 \let\thiscaption=\empty
7668 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
7670 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
7672 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
7673 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
7675 \startsavinginserts
7677 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
7678 \par
7680 \vtop\bgroup
7681 \def\floattype{#1}%
7682 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
7683 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
7685 \ifx\floattype\empty
7686 \let\safefloattype=\empty
7687 \else
7689 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7690 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7691 \indexnofonts
7692 \turnoffactive
7693 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7697 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
7698 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7699 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
7700 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
7702 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
7703 \global\advance\floatno by 1
7706 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
7707 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
7708 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
7709 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
7710 % lists of floats.
7712 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
7713 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
7717 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
7718 \vskip\parskip
7720 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
7721 \restorefirstparagraphindent
7724 % we have these possibilities:
7725 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
7726 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
7727 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
7728 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
7729 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
7730 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
7731 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
7732 % @float & no caption:
7734 \def\Efloat{%
7735 \let\floatident = \empty
7737 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
7738 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
7740 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
7741 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7742 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
7743 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
7745 % the number.
7746 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7749 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
7750 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
7751 \let\captionline = \floatident
7753 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
7754 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
7755 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
7758 % caption text.
7759 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
7762 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
7763 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
7764 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
7765 \vskip.5\parskip
7766 \captionline
7768 % Space below caption.
7769 \vskip\parskip
7772 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
7773 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
7774 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
7775 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
7776 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
7777 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
7779 \atdummies
7781 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
7782 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
7783 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
7784 \scanexp{%
7785 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
7786 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
7787 \thiscaption
7788 \else
7789 \thisshortcaption
7793 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
7794 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
7797 \egroup % end of \vtop
7799 % place the captured inserts
7801 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
7802 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
7803 % float. --kasal, 26may04
7805 \checkinserts
7808 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
7810 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
7811 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
7814 % @caption, @shortcaption
7816 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
7817 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
7818 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
7819 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
7821 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
7822 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
7823 \def\getfloatno#1{%
7824 \ifx#1\relax
7825 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
7826 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
7828 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
7829 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
7830 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
7832 \let\floatno#1%
7835 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
7836 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
7837 % first read the @float command.
7839 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
7841 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
7842 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
7843 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
7845 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
7846 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
7847 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
7849 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
7851 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
7852 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
7854 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
7855 \def\temp{#1}%
7856 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
7857 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
7860 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
7862 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
7863 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
7865 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
7866 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
7867 \indexnofonts
7868 \turnoffactive
7869 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
7872 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
7873 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
7874 \ifhavexrefs
7875 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
7876 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
7878 \else
7879 \begingroup
7880 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
7881 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
7882 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
7883 \endgroup
7887 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
7888 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
7889 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
7890 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
7892 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
7893 % they won't appear in the aux file).
7895 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
7896 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
7897 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
7898 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
7899 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
7900 % in pdf output.
7901 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
7903 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
7904 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
7905 \writeentry
7909 \message{localization,}
7911 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
7912 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
7913 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
7916 \catcode`\_ = \active
7917 \globaldefs=1
7918 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
7919 \let_=\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
7920 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
7921 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
7922 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
7923 \ifeof 1
7924 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}%
7925 \else
7926 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
7927 \input txi-#1.tex
7929 \closein 1
7930 \endgroup % end raw TeX
7931 \endgroup}
7934 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
7935 % try txi-de.tex.
7937 \def\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
7938 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
7939 \ifeof 1
7940 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
7941 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
7942 \else
7943 \input txi-#1.tex
7945 \closein 1
7948 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
7949 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
7950 directory should work if nowhere else does.}
7952 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
7953 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
7954 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
7956 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
7957 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
7958 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
7960 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
7961 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
7962 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
7963 % accented characters problem.)
7965 \catcode`@=11
7966 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
7967 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
7968 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
7969 \message{no patterns for #1}%
7970 \else
7971 \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
7973 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
7974 \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
7975 \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
7978 % Helpers for encodings.
7979 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
7981 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
7982 \count255=128
7983 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
7984 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
7985 \advance\count255 by 1
7986 \repeat
7989 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
7990 \count255=128
7991 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
7992 \catcode\count255=#1\relax
7993 \advance\count255 by 1
7994 \repeat
7997 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
7998 % according to the specified encoding.
8000 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
8001 % Encoding being declared for the document.
8002 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
8004 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
8005 % to compare them with \ifx.
8006 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
8007 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
8008 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
8009 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
8010 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
8012 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
8013 \asciichardefs
8015 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
8016 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8017 \lattwochardefs
8019 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
8020 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8021 \latonechardefs
8023 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
8024 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8025 \latninechardefs
8027 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
8028 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8029 \utfeightchardefs
8031 \else
8032 \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
8034 \fi % utfeight
8035 \fi % latnine
8036 \fi % latone
8037 \fi % lattwo
8038 \fi % ascii
8041 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
8042 % the default font encoding (OT1).
8044 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
8046 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
8047 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
8049 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
8050 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
8051 % macros containing the character definitions.
8052 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8054 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
8055 \def\latonechardefs{%
8056 \gdef^^a0{~}
8057 \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
8058 \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
8059 \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
8060 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
8061 \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
8062 \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
8063 \gdef^^a7{\S}
8064 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
8065 \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
8066 \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
8067 \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft}
8068 \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
8069 \gdef^^ad{\-}
8070 \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
8071 \gdef^^af{\={}}
8073 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
8074 \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
8075 \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
8076 \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
8077 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
8078 \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
8079 \gdef^^b6{\P}
8081 \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
8082 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
8083 \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
8084 \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
8086 \gdef^^bb{\guilletright}
8087 \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
8088 \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
8089 \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
8090 \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
8092 \gdef^^c0{\`A}
8093 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
8094 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
8095 \gdef^^c3{\~A}
8096 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
8097 \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
8098 \gdef^^c6{\AE}
8099 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
8100 \gdef^^c8{\`E}
8101 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
8102 \gdef^^ca{\^E}
8103 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
8104 \gdef^^cc{\`I}
8105 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
8106 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
8107 \gdef^^cf{\"I}
8109 \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER ETH}}
8110 \gdef^^d1{\~N}
8111 \gdef^^d2{\`O}
8112 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
8113 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
8114 \gdef^^d5{\~O}
8115 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
8116 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
8117 \gdef^^d8{\O}
8118 \gdef^^d9{\`U}
8119 \gdef^^da{\'U}
8120 \gdef^^db{\^U}
8121 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
8122 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
8123 \gdef^^de{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER THORN}}
8124 \gdef^^df{\ss}
8126 \gdef^^e0{\`a}
8127 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
8128 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
8129 \gdef^^e3{\~a}
8130 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
8131 \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
8132 \gdef^^e6{\ae}
8133 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
8134 \gdef^^e8{\`e}
8135 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
8136 \gdef^^ea{\^e}
8137 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
8138 \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
8139 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
8140 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
8141 \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
8143 \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER ETH}}
8144 \gdef^^f1{\~n}
8145 \gdef^^f2{\`o}
8146 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
8147 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
8148 \gdef^^f5{\~o}
8149 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
8150 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
8151 \gdef^^f8{\o}
8152 \gdef^^f9{\`u}
8153 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
8154 \gdef^^fb{\^u}
8155 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
8156 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
8157 \gdef^^fe{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER THORN}}
8158 \gdef^^ff{\"y}
8161 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
8162 \def\latninechardefs{%
8163 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
8164 \latonechardefs
8166 \gdef^^a4{\euro}
8167 \gdef^^a6{\v S}
8168 \gdef^^a8{\v s}
8169 \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
8170 \gdef^^b8{\v z}
8171 \gdef^^bc{\OE}
8172 \gdef^^bd{\oe}
8173 \gdef^^be{\"Y}
8176 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
8177 \def\lattwochardefs{%
8178 \gdef^^a0{~}
8179 \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
8180 \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
8181 \gdef^^a3{\L}
8182 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
8183 \gdef^^a5{\v L}
8184 \gdef^^a6{\'S}
8185 \gdef^^a7{\S}
8186 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
8187 \gdef^^a9{\v S}
8188 \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
8189 \gdef^^ab{\v T}
8190 \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
8191 \gdef^^ad{\-}
8192 \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
8193 \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
8195 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
8196 \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
8197 \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
8198 \gdef^^b3{\l}
8199 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
8200 \gdef^^b5{\v l}
8201 \gdef^^b6{\'s}
8202 \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
8203 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
8204 \gdef^^b9{\v s}
8205 \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
8206 \gdef^^bb{\v t}
8207 \gdef^^bc{\'z}
8208 \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
8209 \gdef^^be{\v z}
8210 \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
8212 \gdef^^c0{\'R}
8213 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
8214 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
8215 \gdef^^c3{\u A}
8216 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
8217 \gdef^^c5{\'L}
8218 \gdef^^c6{\'C}
8219 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
8220 \gdef^^c8{\v C}
8221 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
8222 \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
8223 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
8224 \gdef^^cc{\v E}
8225 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
8226 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
8227 \gdef^^cf{\v D}
8229 \gdef^^d0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN CAPITAL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
8230 \gdef^^d1{\'N}
8231 \gdef^^d2{\v N}
8232 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
8233 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
8234 \gdef^^d5{\H O}
8235 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
8236 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
8237 \gdef^^d8{\v R}
8238 \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
8239 \gdef^^da{\'U}
8240 \gdef^^db{\H U}
8241 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
8242 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
8243 \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
8244 \gdef^^df{\ss}
8246 \gdef^^e0{\'r}
8247 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
8248 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
8249 \gdef^^e3{\u a}
8250 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
8251 \gdef^^e5{\'l}
8252 \gdef^^e6{\'c}
8253 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
8254 \gdef^^e8{\v c}
8255 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
8256 \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
8257 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
8258 \gdef^^ec{\v e}
8259 \gdef^^ed{\'\i}
8260 \gdef^^ee{\^\i}
8261 \gdef^^ef{\v d}
8263 \gdef^^f0{\missingcharmsg{LATIN SMALL LETTER D WITH STROKE}}
8264 \gdef^^f1{\'n}
8265 \gdef^^f2{\v n}
8266 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
8267 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
8268 \gdef^^f5{\H o}
8269 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
8270 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
8271 \gdef^^f8{\v r}
8272 \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
8273 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
8274 \gdef^^fb{\H u}
8275 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
8276 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
8277 \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
8278 \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
8281 % UTF-8 character definitions.
8283 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
8284 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
8285 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
8287 \newcount\countUTFx
8288 \newcount\countUTFy
8289 \newcount\countUTFz
8291 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
8292 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
8294 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
8295 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
8297 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
8298 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
8300 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
8301 \ifx #1\relax
8302 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
8303 \else
8304 \expandafter #1%
8308 \begingroup
8309 \catcode`\~13
8310 \catcode`\"12
8312 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
8313 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
8314 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
8315 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
8316 \advance\countUTFx by 1
8317 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
8318 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
8319 \fi}
8321 \countUTFx = "C2
8322 \countUTFy = "E0
8323 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
8324 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
8325 \UTFviiiLoop
8327 \countUTFx = "E0
8328 \countUTFy = "F0
8329 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
8330 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
8331 \UTFviiiLoop
8333 \countUTFx = "F0
8334 \countUTFy = "F4
8335 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
8336 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
8337 \UTFviiiLoop
8338 \endgroup
8340 \begingroup
8341 \catcode`\"=12
8342 \catcode`\<=12
8343 \catcode`\.=12
8344 \catcode`\,=12
8345 \catcode`\;=12
8346 \catcode`\!=12
8347 \catcode`\~=13
8349 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
8350 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
8351 \wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
8352 \begingroup
8353 \parseXMLCharref
8354 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
8355 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
8356 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
8357 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
8358 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
8359 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
8360 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
8361 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
8362 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
8363 \endgroup}
8365 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
8366 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
8367 \errhelp = \EMsimple
8368 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
8369 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
8370 \parseUTFviiiA,%
8371 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
8372 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
8373 \parseUTFviiiA;%
8374 \parseUTFviiiA,%
8375 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
8376 \else
8377 \parseUTFviiiA;%
8378 \parseUTFviiiA,%
8379 \parseUTFviiiA!%
8380 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
8381 \fi\fi\fi
8384 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
8385 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
8386 \divide\countUTFz by 64
8387 \countUTFy = \countUTFz
8388 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
8389 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
8390 \advance\countUTFx by 128
8391 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
8392 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
8394 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
8395 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
8396 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
8397 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
8398 \endgroup
8400 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
8401 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
8402 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
8403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
8404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
8405 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
8406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
8407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
8408 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
8409 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
8410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
8412 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
8413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
8414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
8415 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
8416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
8417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
8419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
8420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
8421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
8422 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
8423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
8424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
8425 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
8426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
8427 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
8428 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
8429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
8430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
8431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
8432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
8433 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
8434 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
8436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
8437 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
8438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
8439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
8440 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
8441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
8442 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
8443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
8444 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
8445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
8446 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
8447 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
8448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
8450 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
8451 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
8452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
8453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
8454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
8455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
8456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
8457 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
8458 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
8459 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
8460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
8461 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
8462 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
8463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
8464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
8465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
8467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
8468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
8469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
8470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
8471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
8472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
8473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
8474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
8475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
8476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
8477 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
8478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
8479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
8481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
8482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
8483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
8484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
8485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}
8486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}
8487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
8488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
8489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
8490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
8491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}
8492 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}
8493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
8494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
8495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
8496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
8497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
8499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
8500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
8501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
8502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
8503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
8504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
8505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
8506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
8507 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
8508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
8509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
8510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
8512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
8513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
8514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
8515 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
8516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
8517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
8518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
8519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
8520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
8521 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
8523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
8524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
8525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
8526 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
8527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
8528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
8529 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
8530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
8532 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
8533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
8534 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
8535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
8536 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
8537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
8538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
8539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
8540 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
8541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
8543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
8544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
8545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
8546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
8547 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
8548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
8549 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
8550 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
8551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
8552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
8553 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
8554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
8555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
8556 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
8558 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
8559 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
8560 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
8561 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
8562 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
8564 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
8565 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
8566 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
8567 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
8568 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
8569 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
8570 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
8571 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
8573 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
8574 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
8575 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
8576 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
8577 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
8578 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
8579 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
8580 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
8581 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
8582 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
8583 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
8584 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
8585 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
8587 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
8588 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
8589 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
8590 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
8591 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
8592 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
8593 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
8594 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
8595 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
8596 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
8597 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
8598 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
8600 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
8601 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
8602 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
8603 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
8604 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
8606 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
8607 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
8608 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
8609 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
8610 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
8611 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
8613 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
8614 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
8615 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
8616 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
8617 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
8618 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
8619 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
8620 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
8621 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
8622 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
8623 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
8624 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
8626 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
8627 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
8629 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
8630 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
8631 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
8632 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
8633 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
8634 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
8636 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
8637 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
8638 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
8640 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}
8642 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
8643 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
8644 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
8645 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
8646 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
8647 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
8648 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
8649 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
8650 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
8651 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
8652 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
8653 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
8655 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
8656 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
8658 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
8659 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
8660 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
8661 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
8662 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
8663 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
8664 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
8665 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
8667 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
8668 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
8669 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
8670 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
8671 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
8672 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
8673 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
8674 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
8675 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
8676 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
8677 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
8678 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
8680 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
8681 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
8682 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
8683 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
8684 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
8685 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
8686 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
8687 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
8688 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
8689 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
8691 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
8692 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
8693 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
8694 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
8695 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
8696 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
8697 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
8698 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
8699 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
8700 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
8702 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
8703 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
8704 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
8705 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
8706 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
8707 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
8708 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
8709 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
8710 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
8711 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
8713 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
8714 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
8715 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
8716 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
8718 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
8719 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
8720 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
8721 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
8722 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
8723 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
8724 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
8725 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
8726 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
8727 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
8728 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
8729 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
8730 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
8731 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
8732 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
8733 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
8735 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
8736 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
8737 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
8738 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
8739 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
8740 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
8741 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
8742 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
8743 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
8744 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
8746 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
8747 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
8749 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
8750 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
8751 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
8752 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
8754 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
8755 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
8756 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
8757 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
8759 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
8760 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
8762 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
8763 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
8764 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
8766 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
8767 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
8769 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
8770 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
8771 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
8772 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
8773 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
8774 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
8775 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
8776 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
8777 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
8778 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
8779 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
8780 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
8781 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
8783 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
8784 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
8786 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
8787 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
8788 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
8789 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
8792 % US-ASCII character definitions.
8793 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
8794 \relax
8797 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
8798 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
8799 % document encoding.
8801 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
8804 \message{formatting,}
8806 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
8808 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
8809 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
8810 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
8812 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
8813 \vbadness = 10000
8815 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
8816 \hbadness = 2000
8818 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
8819 \widowpenalty=10000
8820 \clubpenalty=10000
8822 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
8823 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
8824 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
8825 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
8827 \def\setemergencystretch{%
8828 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
8829 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
8830 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
8831 \else
8832 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
8836 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
8837 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
8838 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
8840 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
8841 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
8843 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
8844 \voffset = #3\relax
8845 \topskip = #6\relax
8846 \splittopskip = \topskip
8848 \vsize = #1\relax
8849 \advance\vsize by \topskip
8850 \outervsize = \vsize
8851 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
8852 \pageheight = \vsize
8854 \hsize = #2\relax
8855 \outerhsize = \hsize
8856 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
8857 \pagewidth = \hsize
8859 \normaloffset = #4\relax
8860 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
8862 \ifpdf
8863 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
8864 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
8865 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
8866 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
8867 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
8868 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
8871 \setleading{\textleading}
8873 \parindent = \defaultparindent
8874 \setemergencystretch
8877 % @letterpaper (the default).
8878 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8879 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8880 \textleading = 13.2pt
8882 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
8883 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
8884 {\voffset}{.25in}%
8885 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
8886 {11in}{8.5in}%
8889 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
8890 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
8891 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
8892 \textleading = 12pt
8894 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
8895 {-.2in}{0in}%
8896 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
8897 {9.25in}{7in}%
8899 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
8900 \tolerance = 700
8901 \hfuzz = 1pt
8902 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8903 \defbodyindent = .5cm
8906 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
8907 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
8908 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
8909 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
8910 \textleading = 12pt
8912 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
8913 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
8914 {0pt}{14pt}%
8915 {9in}{6in}%
8917 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
8918 \tolerance = 700
8919 \hfuzz = 1pt
8920 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8921 \defbodyindent = .4cm
8924 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
8925 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8926 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
8927 \textleading = 13.2pt
8929 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
8930 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
8931 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
8932 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
8933 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
8934 % your texinfo source file like this:
8935 % @tex
8936 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
8937 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
8938 % @end tex
8939 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
8940 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8941 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
8942 {297mm}{210mm}%
8944 \tolerance = 700
8945 \hfuzz = 1pt
8946 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8947 \defbodyindent = 5mm
8950 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
8951 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
8952 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
8953 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
8954 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
8955 \textleading = 12.5pt
8957 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
8958 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
8959 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
8960 {210mm}{148mm}%
8962 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
8963 \tolerance = 800
8964 \hfuzz = 1.2pt
8965 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
8966 \defbodyindent = 2mm
8967 \tableindent = 12mm
8970 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
8971 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
8972 \afourpaper
8973 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
8974 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
8975 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
8976 {297mm}{210mm}%
8978 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
8979 \globaldefs = 0
8982 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
8983 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
8984 \afourpaper
8985 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
8986 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
8987 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
8988 {297mm}{210mm}%
8989 \globaldefs = 0
8992 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
8993 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
8994 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
8996 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
8997 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
8998 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
8999 \globaldefs = 1
9001 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
9002 \setleading{\textleading}%
9004 \dimen0 = #1\relax
9005 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
9007 \dimen2 = \hsize
9008 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
9010 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
9011 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
9012 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
9013 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
9016 % Set default to letter.
9018 \letterpaper
9021 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
9023 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
9024 \catcode`\^^? = 14
9026 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
9027 \catcode`\"=\other
9028 \catcode`\~=\other
9029 \catcode`\^=\other
9030 \catcode`\_=\other
9031 \catcode`\|=\other
9032 \catcode`\<=\other
9033 \catcode`\>=\other
9034 \catcode`\+=\other
9035 \catcode`\$=\other
9036 \def\normaldoublequote{"}
9037 \def\normaltilde{~}
9038 \def\normalcaret{^}
9039 \def\normalunderscore{_}
9040 \def\normalverticalbar{|}
9041 \def\normalless{<}
9042 \def\normalgreater{>}
9043 \def\normalplus{+}
9044 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
9046 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
9047 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
9048 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
9050 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
9051 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
9052 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
9053 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
9055 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
9057 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
9058 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
9059 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
9060 % this is not a problem.
9061 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
9063 % Turn off all special characters except @
9064 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
9065 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
9066 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
9068 \catcode`\"=\active
9069 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
9070 \let"=\activedoublequote
9071 \catcode`\~=\active
9072 \def~{{\tt\char126}}
9073 \chardef\hat=`\^
9074 \catcode`\^=\active
9075 \def^{{\tt \hat}}
9077 \catcode`\_=\active
9078 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
9079 \let\realunder=_
9080 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
9081 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
9083 \catcode`\|=\active
9084 \def|{{\tt\char124}}
9085 \chardef \less=`\<
9086 \catcode`\<=\active
9087 \def<{{\tt \less}}
9088 \chardef \gtr=`\>
9089 \catcode`\>=\active
9090 \def>{{\tt \gtr}}
9091 \catcode`\+=\active
9092 \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
9093 \catcode`\$=\active
9094 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
9096 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
9097 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
9098 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
9099 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
9100 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
9102 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
9103 % parsing them.
9104 \def\turnoffactive{%
9105 \normalturnoffactive
9106 \otherbackslash
9109 \catcode`\@=0
9111 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
9112 % as in \char`\\.
9113 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
9114 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
9116 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
9117 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
9118 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
9120 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
9121 % in fixed width font.
9122 \catcode`\\=\active
9123 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}}
9124 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
9125 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
9127 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
9128 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
9129 % catcode other.
9130 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
9131 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
9133 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
9134 % the literal character `\'.
9136 @def@normalturnoffactive{%
9137 @let\=@normalbackslash
9138 @let"=@normaldoublequote
9139 @let~=@normaltilde
9140 @let^=@normalcaret
9141 @let_=@normalunderscore
9142 @let|=@normalverticalbar
9143 @let<=@normalless
9144 @let>=@normalgreater
9145 @let+=@normalplus
9146 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
9147 @markupsetuplqdefault
9148 @markupsetuprqdefault
9149 @unsepspaces
9152 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
9153 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
9154 @otherifyactive
9156 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
9157 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
9158 % a backslash.
9160 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
9161 @global@let\ = @eatinput
9163 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
9164 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
9165 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
9166 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
9167 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
9169 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
9170 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
9171 @catcode`+=@active
9172 @catcode`@_=@active
9175 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
9176 @escapechar = `@@
9178 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
9179 @catcode`@& = @other
9180 @catcode`@# = @other
9181 @catcode`@% = @other
9183 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
9184 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
9185 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
9186 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
9187 @catcode`@'=@active
9188 @catcode`@`=@active
9189 @markupsetuplqdefault
9190 @markupsetuprqdefault
9192 @c Local variables:
9193 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
9194 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
9195 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
9196 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
9197 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
9198 @c End:
9200 @c vim:sw=2:
9202 @ignore
9203 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
9204 @end ignore